1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H 3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H 4 /* 5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface 6 * 7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2024 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #include <linux/ethtool.h> 14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h> 15 #include <linux/netdevice.h> 16 #include <linux/debugfs.h> 17 #include <linux/list.h> 18 #include <linux/bug.h> 19 #include <linux/netlink.h> 20 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 21 #include <linux/nl80211.h> 22 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 24 #include <linux/net.h> 25 #include <linux/rfkill.h> 26 #include <net/regulatory.h> 27 28 /** 29 * DOC: Introduction 30 * 31 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges 32 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated 33 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used 34 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent 35 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers 36 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely. 37 * 38 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum 39 * use restrictions. 40 */ 41 42 43 /** 44 * DOC: Device registration 45 * 46 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device 47 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs 48 * described below. 49 * 50 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each 51 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each 52 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with 53 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's 54 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes 55 * the wireless part of the interface. Normally this struct is embedded in the 56 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating 57 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the 58 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful. 59 * 60 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has 61 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and 62 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail. 63 */ 64 65 struct wiphy; 66 67 /* 68 * wireless hardware capability structures 69 */ 70 71 /** 72 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags 73 * 74 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code. 75 * 76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled. 77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes 78 * sending probe requests or beaconing. 79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this 80 * channel. 81 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel. 82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel 83 * is not permitted. 84 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel 85 * is not permitted. 86 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel. 87 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band, 88 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this 89 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 90 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 91 * restrictions. 92 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band, 93 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this 94 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 95 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 96 * restrictions. 97 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY 98 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 100 * on this channel. 101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 102 * on this channel. 103 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel. 104 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted 105 * on this channel. 106 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted 107 * on this channel. 108 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted 109 * on this channel. 110 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted 111 * on this channel. 112 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted 113 * on this channel. 114 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band, 115 * this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this 116 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 117 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 118 * restrictions. 119 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel. 120 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT 121 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection with VLP AP 122 * not permitted using this channel 123 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection with AFC AP 124 * not permitted using this channel 125 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used for monitor 126 * mode even in the presence of other (regulatory) restrictions, 127 * even if it is otherwise disabled. 128 */ 129 enum ieee80211_channel_flags { 130 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = 1<<0, 131 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = 1<<1, 132 IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD = 1<<2, 133 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = 1<<3, 134 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<4, 135 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<5, 136 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = 1<<6, 137 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = 1<<7, 138 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = 1<<8, 139 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = 1<<9, 140 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<10, 141 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = 1<<11, 142 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = 1<<12, 143 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = 1<<13, 144 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = 1<<14, 145 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = 1<<15, 146 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = 1<<16, 147 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = 1<<17, 148 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = 1<<18, 149 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ = 1<<19, 150 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT = 1<<20, 151 IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT = 1<<21, 152 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT = 1<<22, 153 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT = 1<<23, 154 IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR = 1<<24, 155 }; 156 157 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \ 158 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS) 159 160 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000 161 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000) 162 163 /** 164 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition 165 * 166 * This structure describes a single channel for use 167 * with cfg80211. 168 * 169 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz 170 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz 171 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel 172 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags. 173 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory 174 * code to support devices with additional restrictions 175 * @band: band this channel belongs to. 176 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi 177 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm) 178 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm) 179 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon 180 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon() 181 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band. 182 * @orig_mag: internal use 183 * @orig_mpwr: internal use 184 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required 185 * on this channel. 186 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 187 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels. 188 * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm) 189 */ 190 struct ieee80211_channel { 191 enum nl80211_band band; 192 u32 center_freq; 193 u16 freq_offset; 194 u16 hw_value; 195 u32 flags; 196 int max_antenna_gain; 197 int max_power; 198 int max_reg_power; 199 bool beacon_found; 200 u32 orig_flags; 201 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr; 202 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state; 203 unsigned long dfs_state_entered; 204 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms; 205 s8 psd; 206 }; 207 208 /** 209 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags 210 * 211 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured 212 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for 213 * different bands/PHY modes. 214 * 215 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short 216 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and 217 * with CCK rates. 218 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 219 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the 220 * core code when registering the wiphy. 221 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 222 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 223 * core code when registering the wiphy. 224 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 225 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 226 * core code when registering the wiphy. 227 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode. 228 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode 229 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode 230 */ 231 enum ieee80211_rate_flags { 232 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<0, 233 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = 1<<1, 234 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = 1<<2, 235 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = 1<<3, 236 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = 1<<4, 237 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = 1<<5, 238 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = 1<<6, 239 }; 240 241 /** 242 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter 243 * 244 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS 245 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS 246 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS 247 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS 248 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type 249 */ 250 enum ieee80211_bss_type { 251 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS, 252 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS, 253 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 254 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS, 255 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY 256 }; 257 258 /** 259 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter 260 * 261 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set 262 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear 263 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting 264 */ 265 enum ieee80211_privacy { 266 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON, 267 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF, 268 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY 269 }; 270 271 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \ 272 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF) 273 274 /** 275 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition 276 * 277 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can 278 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short 279 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are 280 * passed around. 281 * 282 * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags 283 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps 284 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate 285 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when 286 * short preamble is used 287 */ 288 struct ieee80211_rate { 289 u32 flags; 290 u16 bitrate; 291 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short; 292 }; 293 294 /** 295 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse 296 * 297 * @enable: is the feature enabled. 298 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element. 299 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset 300 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use 301 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use 302 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by 303 * members of the SRG 304 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values 305 * used by members of the SRG 306 */ 307 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd { 308 bool enable; 309 u8 sr_ctrl; 310 u8 non_srg_max_offset; 311 u8 min_offset; 312 u8 max_offset; 313 u8 bss_color_bitmap[8]; 314 u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8]; 315 }; 316 317 /** 318 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring 319 * 320 * @color: the current color. 321 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used 322 * @partial: define the AID equation. 323 */ 324 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color { 325 u8 color; 326 bool enabled; 327 bool partial; 328 }; 329 330 /** 331 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities 332 * 333 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 334 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA. 335 * 336 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA 337 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec 338 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor 339 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing 340 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates 341 */ 342 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap { 343 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */ 344 bool ht_supported; 345 u8 ampdu_factor; 346 u8 ampdu_density; 347 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs; 348 }; 349 350 /** 351 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities 352 * 353 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 354 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA. 355 * 356 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA 357 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec 358 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates 359 */ 360 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap { 361 bool vht_supported; 362 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */ 363 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs; 364 }; 365 366 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25 367 368 /** 369 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities 370 * 371 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 372 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA. 373 * 374 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid. 375 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element. 376 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. 377 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. 378 */ 379 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap { 380 bool has_he; 381 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem; 382 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp; 383 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; 384 }; 385 386 /** 387 * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS 388 * 389 * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS 390 * and NSS Set field" 391 * 392 * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA. 393 * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz 394 * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz 395 * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz 396 * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz 397 */ 398 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp { 399 union { 400 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz; 401 struct { 402 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80; 403 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160; 404 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320; 405 } __packed bw; 406 } __packed; 407 } __packed; 408 409 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 32 410 411 /** 412 * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities 413 * 414 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 415 * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA. 416 * 417 * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid. 418 * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element. 419 * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. 420 * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. 421 */ 422 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap { 423 bool has_eht; 424 struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem; 425 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp; 426 u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; 427 }; 428 429 /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */ 430 #ifdef __CHECKER__ 431 /* 432 * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed 433 * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot 434 * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be 435 * noisy when the pointer is used directly. 436 */ 437 # define __iftd __attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data))) 438 #else 439 # define __iftd 440 #endif /* __CHECKER__ */ 441 442 /** 443 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type 444 * 445 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the 446 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the 447 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data. 448 * 449 * @types_mask: interface types mask 450 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities 451 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a 452 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value). 453 * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities 454 * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise 455 * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data 456 * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length 457 */ 458 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data { 459 u16 types_mask; 460 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 461 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 462 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap; 463 struct { 464 const u8 *data; 465 unsigned int len; 466 } vendor_elems; 467 }; 468 469 /** 470 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations 471 * 472 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz 473 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz 474 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz 475 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz 476 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 477 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 478 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 479 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and 480 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 481 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 482 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 483 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 484 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 485 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 486 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 487 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz, 488 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 489 */ 490 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config { 491 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4, 492 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5, 493 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6, 494 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7, 495 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8, 496 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9, 497 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10, 498 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11, 499 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12, 500 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13, 501 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14, 502 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15, 503 }; 504 505 /** 506 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration 507 * 508 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 509 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration 510 * 511 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s) 512 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions. 513 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc. 514 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported. 515 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 516 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations 517 */ 518 struct ieee80211_edmg { 519 u8 channels; 520 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config; 521 }; 522 523 /** 524 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities 525 * 526 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 527 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA. 528 * 529 * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA 530 * @cap: S1G capabilities information 531 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set 532 */ 533 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap { 534 bool s1g; 535 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */ 536 u8 nss_mcs[5]; 537 }; 538 539 /** 540 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition 541 * 542 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy 543 * is able to operate in. 544 * 545 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with 546 * in this band. 547 * @band: the band this structure represents 548 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels 549 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with 550 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported 551 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM. 552 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates 553 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band 554 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band 555 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band 556 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band 557 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course) 558 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries 559 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in 560 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only 561 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of 562 * iftype_data). 563 */ 564 struct ieee80211_supported_band { 565 struct ieee80211_channel *channels; 566 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates; 567 enum nl80211_band band; 568 int n_channels; 569 int n_bitrates; 570 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 571 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 572 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap; 573 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap; 574 u16 n_iftype_data; 575 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data; 576 }; 577 578 /** 579 * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array 580 * @sband: the sband to initialize 581 * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer 582 * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array 583 * 584 * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot 585 * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer 586 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used. 587 */ 588 static inline void 589 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 590 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd, 591 u16 n_iftd) 592 { 593 sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd; 594 sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd; 595 } 596 597 /** 598 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array 599 * @sband: the sband to initialize 600 * @iftd: the iftype data array 601 */ 602 #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd) \ 603 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd)) 604 605 /** 606 * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries 607 * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate 608 * @i: iterator counter 609 * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set 610 */ 611 #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd) \ 612 for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i]; \ 613 i < (sband)->n_iftype_data; \ 614 i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i]) 615 616 /** 617 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype 618 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 619 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 620 * 621 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found 622 */ 623 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * 624 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 625 u8 iftype) 626 { 627 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data; 628 int i; 629 630 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX)) 631 return NULL; 632 633 if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN) 634 iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP; 635 636 for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) { 637 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype)) 638 return data; 639 } 640 641 return NULL; 642 } 643 644 /** 645 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype 646 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 647 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 648 * 649 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 650 */ 651 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 652 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 653 u8 iftype) 654 { 655 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 656 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 657 658 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he) 659 return &data->he_cap; 660 661 return NULL; 662 } 663 664 /** 665 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 666 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 667 * @iftype: the iftype to search for 668 * 669 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 670 */ 671 static inline __le16 672 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 673 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 674 { 675 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 676 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 677 678 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he)) 679 return 0; 680 681 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa; 682 } 683 684 /** 685 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype 686 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 687 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 688 * 689 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found 690 */ 691 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap * 692 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 693 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 694 { 695 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 696 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 697 698 if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht) 699 return &data->eht_cap; 700 701 return NULL; 702 } 703 704 /** 705 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree 706 * 707 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for 708 * 709 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful 710 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board 711 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier). 712 * 713 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable 714 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with 715 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make 716 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified 717 * without affecting other devices. 718 * 719 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev. 720 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first. 721 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register(). 722 */ 723 #ifdef CONFIG_OF 724 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy); 725 #else /* CONFIG_OF */ 726 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy) 727 { 728 } 729 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */ 730 731 732 /* 733 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods 734 */ 735 736 /** 737 * DOC: Actions and configuration 738 * 739 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration 740 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these 741 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these 742 * operations use are described separately. 743 * 744 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status 745 * information via some functions that drivers need to call. 746 * 747 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described 748 * in a separate chapter. 749 */ 750 751 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\ 752 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN) 753 754 /** 755 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters 756 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise 757 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set 758 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames 759 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface. 760 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may 761 * determine the address as needed. 762 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the 763 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating 764 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC. 765 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets 766 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed 767 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring 768 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed 769 */ 770 struct vif_params { 771 u32 flags; 772 int use_4addr; 773 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN]; 774 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups; 775 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr; 776 }; 777 778 /** 779 * struct key_params - key information 780 * 781 * Information about a key 782 * 783 * @key: key material 784 * @key_len: length of key material 785 * @cipher: cipher suite selector 786 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used 787 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian, 788 * length given by @seq_len. 789 * @seq_len: length of @seq. 790 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero) 791 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX) 792 */ 793 struct key_params { 794 const u8 *key; 795 const u8 *seq; 796 int key_len; 797 int seq_len; 798 u16 vlan_id; 799 u32 cipher; 800 enum nl80211_key_mode mode; 801 }; 802 803 /** 804 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition 805 * @chan: the (control) channel 806 * @width: channel width 807 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment 808 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment 809 * (only with 80+80 MHz) 810 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration. 811 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero), 812 * chan will define the primary channel and all other 813 * parameters are ignored. 814 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz 815 * @punctured: mask of the punctured 20 MHz subchannels, with 816 * bits turned on being disabled (punctured); numbered 817 * from lower to higher frequency (like in the spec) 818 */ 819 struct cfg80211_chan_def { 820 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 821 enum nl80211_chan_width width; 822 u32 center_freq1; 823 u32 center_freq2; 824 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 825 u16 freq1_offset; 826 u16 punctured; 827 }; 828 829 /* 830 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control 831 */ 832 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask { 833 struct { 834 u32 legacy; 835 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN]; 836 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 837 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; 838 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi; 839 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi; 840 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf; 841 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 842 }; 843 844 845 /** 846 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration 847 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration 848 * of the peer. 849 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify 850 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed, 851 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp. 852 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID 853 * @retry_long: retry count value 854 * @retry_short: retry count value 855 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation 856 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS 857 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation 858 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type 859 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID 860 */ 861 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg { 862 bool config_override; 863 u8 tids; 864 u64 mask; 865 enum nl80211_tid_config noack; 866 u8 retry_long, retry_short; 867 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu; 868 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts; 869 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu; 870 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type; 871 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask; 872 }; 873 874 /** 875 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration 876 * @peer: Station's MAC address 877 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied 878 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info 879 */ 880 struct cfg80211_tid_config { 881 const u8 *peer; 882 u32 n_tid_conf; 883 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf); 884 }; 885 886 /** 887 * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data 888 * @macaddr: STA MAC address 889 * @kek: FILS KEK 890 * @kek_len: FILS KEK length 891 * @snonce: STA Nonce 892 * @anonce: AP Nonce 893 */ 894 struct cfg80211_fils_aad { 895 const u8 *macaddr; 896 const u8 *kek; 897 u8 kek_len; 898 const u8 *snonce; 899 const u8 *anonce; 900 }; 901 902 /** 903 * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping 904 * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all 905 * addresses. 906 * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address. 907 * Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address. 908 */ 909 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp { 910 const u8 *macaddr; 911 bool enable; 912 }; 913 914 /** 915 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef 916 * @chandef: the channel definition 917 * 918 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given 919 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion. 920 */ 921 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type 922 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 923 { 924 switch (chandef->width) { 925 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 926 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 927 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 928 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20; 929 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 930 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq) 931 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS; 932 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS; 933 default: 934 WARN_ON(1); 935 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 936 } 937 } 938 939 /** 940 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type 941 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill 942 * @channel: the control channel 943 * @chantype: the channel type 944 * 945 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition. 946 */ 947 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 948 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 949 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype); 950 951 /** 952 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical 953 * @chandef1: first channel definition 954 * @chandef2: second channel definition 955 * 956 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are 957 * identical, %false otherwise. 958 */ 959 static inline bool 960 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 961 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2) 962 { 963 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan && 964 chandef1->width == chandef2->width && 965 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 && 966 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset && 967 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2 && 968 chandef1->punctured == chandef2->punctured); 969 } 970 971 /** 972 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel 973 * 974 * @chandef: the channel definition 975 * 976 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise. 977 */ 978 static inline bool 979 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 980 { 981 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config; 982 } 983 984 /** 985 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible 986 * @chandef1: first channel definition 987 * @chandef2: second channel definition 988 * 989 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible, 990 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise. 991 */ 992 const struct cfg80211_chan_def * 993 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 994 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2); 995 996 /** 997 * nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz - get the channel width in MHz 998 * @chan_width: the channel width from &enum nl80211_chan_width 999 * 1000 * Return: channel width in MHz if the chan_width from &enum nl80211_chan_width 1001 * is valid. -1 otherwise. 1002 */ 1003 int nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(enum nl80211_chan_width chan_width); 1004 1005 /** 1006 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid 1007 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1008 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise. 1009 */ 1010 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 1011 1012 /** 1013 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used 1014 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 1015 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1016 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set 1017 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise. 1018 */ 1019 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1020 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 1021 u32 prohibited_flags); 1022 1023 /** 1024 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required 1025 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 1026 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1027 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype 1028 * Returns: 1029 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error 1030 */ 1031 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1032 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 1033 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 1034 1035 /** 1036 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we 1037 * can/need start CAC on such channel 1038 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 1039 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1040 * 1041 * Return: true if all channels available and at least 1042 * one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE) 1043 */ 1044 bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1045 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 1046 1047 /** 1048 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given 1049 * channel definition 1050 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 1051 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1052 * 1053 * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition 1054 */ 1055 unsigned int 1056 cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1057 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 1058 1059 /** 1060 * cfg80211_chandef_primary - calculate primary 40/80/160 MHz freq 1061 * @chandef: chandef to calculate for 1062 * @primary_chan_width: primary channel width to calculate center for 1063 * @punctured: punctured sub-channel bitmap, will be recalculated 1064 * according to the new bandwidth, can be %NULL 1065 * 1066 * Returns: the primary 40/80/160 MHz channel center frequency, or -1 1067 * for errors, updating the punctured bitmap 1068 */ 1069 int cfg80211_chandef_primary(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 1070 enum nl80211_chan_width primary_chan_width, 1071 u16 *punctured); 1072 1073 /** 1074 * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition. 1075 * @msg: the msg to send channel definition 1076 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1077 * 1078 * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error 1079 **/ 1080 int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 1081 1082 /** 1083 * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width 1084 * @width: the channel width of the channel 1085 * 1086 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK 1087 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels. 1088 * 1089 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width 1090 */ 1091 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags 1092 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width) 1093 { 1094 switch (width) { 1095 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 1096 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ; 1097 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 1098 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ; 1099 default: 1100 break; 1101 } 1102 return 0; 1103 } 1104 1105 /** 1106 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel 1107 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 1108 * 1109 * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(). 1110 * 1111 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel 1112 */ 1113 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags 1114 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 1115 { 1116 return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width); 1117 } 1118 1119 /** 1120 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef 1121 * 1122 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel 1123 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual 1124 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels. 1125 * 1126 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 1127 * 1128 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef 1129 */ 1130 static inline int 1131 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 1132 { 1133 switch (chandef->width) { 1134 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 1135 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6, 1136 chandef->chan->max_power); 1137 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 1138 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3, 1139 chandef->chan->max_power); 1140 default: 1141 break; 1142 } 1143 return chandef->chan->max_power; 1144 } 1145 1146 /** 1147 * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels 1148 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for 1149 * @band_mask: which bands to check on 1150 * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable, 1151 * %IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account 1152 * 1153 * Return: %true if usable channels found, %false otherwise 1154 */ 1155 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1156 unsigned long band_mask, 1157 u32 prohibited_flags); 1158 1159 /** 1160 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags 1161 * 1162 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in 1163 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 1164 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in 1165 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in 1166 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in 1167 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in 1168 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in 1169 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in 1170 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in 1171 * 1172 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info 1173 * it has filled in during the get_survey(). 1174 */ 1175 enum survey_info_flags { 1176 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0), 1177 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1), 1178 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2), 1179 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3), 1180 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4), 1181 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5), 1182 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6), 1183 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7), 1184 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8), 1185 }; 1186 1187 /** 1188 * struct survey_info - channel survey response 1189 * 1190 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single 1191 * record to report global statistics 1192 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags 1193 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are 1194 * optional 1195 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel) 1196 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy 1197 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy 1198 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data 1199 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data 1200 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning 1201 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS 1202 * 1203 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information. 1204 * 1205 * This structure can later be expanded with things like 1206 * channel duty cycle etc. 1207 */ 1208 struct survey_info { 1209 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 1210 u64 time; 1211 u64 time_busy; 1212 u64 time_ext_busy; 1213 u64 time_rx; 1214 u64 time_tx; 1215 u64 time_scan; 1216 u64 time_bss_rx; 1217 u32 filled; 1218 s8 noise; 1219 }; 1220 1221 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES 10 1222 1223 /** 1224 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings 1225 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled 1226 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions) 1227 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset) 1228 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers 1229 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites 1230 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites 1231 * @akm_suites: AKM suites 1232 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 1233 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 1234 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 1235 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 1236 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be 1237 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports 1238 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port 1239 * protocol frames. 1240 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 1241 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 1242 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control 1243 * port for mac80211 1244 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload) 1245 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE 1246 * offload) 1247 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload) 1248 * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation: 1249 * 1250 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED 1251 * Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any 1252 * preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in 1253 * such a scenario. 1254 * 1255 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK 1256 * Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only 1257 * 1258 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT 1259 * Allow hash-to-element only 1260 * 1261 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH 1262 * Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element 1263 */ 1264 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings { 1265 u32 wpa_versions; 1266 u32 cipher_group; 1267 int n_ciphers_pairwise; 1268 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES]; 1269 int n_akm_suites; 1270 u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES]; 1271 bool control_port; 1272 __be16 control_port_ethertype; 1273 bool control_port_no_encrypt; 1274 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 1275 bool control_port_no_preauth; 1276 const u8 *psk; 1277 const u8 *sae_pwd; 1278 u8 sae_pwd_len; 1279 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe; 1280 }; 1281 1282 /** 1283 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid 1284 * 1285 * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set 1286 * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group. 1287 * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode. 1288 */ 1289 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config { 1290 struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev; 1291 u8 index; 1292 bool ema; 1293 }; 1294 1295 /** 1296 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements 1297 * 1298 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems. 1299 * 1300 * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames. 1301 * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements. 1302 * @elem.len: Length of data. 1303 */ 1304 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems { 1305 u8 cnt; 1306 struct { 1307 const u8 *data; 1308 size_t len; 1309 } elem[] __counted_by(cnt); 1310 }; 1311 1312 /** 1313 * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements 1314 * 1315 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems. 1316 * 1317 * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames. 1318 * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements. 1319 * @elem.len: Length of data. 1320 */ 1321 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems { 1322 u8 cnt; 1323 struct { 1324 const u8 *data; 1325 size_t len; 1326 } elem[] __counted_by(cnt); 1327 }; 1328 1329 /** 1330 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data 1331 * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon 1332 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE) 1333 * or %NULL if not changed 1334 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE) 1335 * or %NULL if not changed 1336 * @head_len: length of @head 1337 * @tail_len: length of @tail 1338 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL 1339 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets 1340 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response 1341 * frames or %NULL 1342 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets 1343 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association 1344 * Response frames or %NULL 1345 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets 1346 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp) 1347 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only) 1348 * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements 1349 * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements 1350 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change 1351 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data) 1352 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token 1353 * (measurement type 8) 1354 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement 1355 * Token (measurement type 11) 1356 * @lci_len: LCI data length 1357 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length 1358 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings 1359 * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color 1360 * attribute is present in beacon data or not. 1361 */ 1362 struct cfg80211_beacon_data { 1363 unsigned int link_id; 1364 1365 const u8 *head, *tail; 1366 const u8 *beacon_ies; 1367 const u8 *proberesp_ies; 1368 const u8 *assocresp_ies; 1369 const u8 *probe_resp; 1370 const u8 *lci; 1371 const u8 *civicloc; 1372 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies; 1373 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies; 1374 s8 ftm_responder; 1375 1376 size_t head_len, tail_len; 1377 size_t beacon_ies_len; 1378 size_t proberesp_ies_len; 1379 size_t assocresp_ies_len; 1380 size_t probe_resp_len; 1381 size_t lci_len; 1382 size_t civicloc_len; 1383 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 1384 bool he_bss_color_valid; 1385 }; 1386 1387 struct mac_address { 1388 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 1389 }; 1390 1391 /** 1392 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data 1393 * 1394 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's 1395 * entry specified by mac_addr 1396 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed 1397 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL 1398 */ 1399 struct cfg80211_acl_data { 1400 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy; 1401 int n_acl_entries; 1402 1403 /* Keep it last */ 1404 struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries); 1405 }; 1406 1407 /** 1408 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 1409 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 1410 * 1411 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated. 1412 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1413 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1414 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1415 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action 1416 * frame headers. 1417 */ 1418 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery { 1419 bool update; 1420 u32 min_interval; 1421 u32 max_interval; 1422 size_t tmpl_len; 1423 const u8 *tmpl; 1424 }; 1425 1426 /** 1427 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe 1428 * response parameters in 6GHz. 1429 * 1430 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated. 1431 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned 1432 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive 1433 * scanning 1434 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1435 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response 1436 */ 1437 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp { 1438 bool update; 1439 u32 interval; 1440 size_t tmpl_len; 1441 const u8 *tmpl; 1442 }; 1443 1444 /** 1445 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration 1446 * 1447 * Used to configure an AP interface. 1448 * 1449 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 1450 * @beacon: beacon data 1451 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1452 * @dtim_period: DTIM period 1453 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from 1454 * user space) 1455 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid 1456 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames 1457 * @crypto: crypto settings 1458 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy 1459 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 1460 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode 1461 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity. 1462 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window 1463 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS 1464 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for 1465 * MAC address based access control 1466 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG 1467 * networks. 1468 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 1469 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled) 1470 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled) 1471 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1472 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled) 1473 * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled) 1474 * @ht_required: stations must support HT 1475 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT 1476 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time 1477 * @he_required: stations must support HE 1478 * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE 1479 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags 1480 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings 1481 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1482 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters 1483 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters 1484 * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid 1485 */ 1486 struct cfg80211_ap_settings { 1487 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1488 1489 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; 1490 1491 int beacon_interval, dtim_period; 1492 const u8 *ssid; 1493 size_t ssid_len; 1494 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid; 1495 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 1496 bool privacy; 1497 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 1498 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1499 int inactivity_timeout; 1500 u8 p2p_ctwindow; 1501 bool p2p_opp_ps; 1502 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl; 1503 bool pbss; 1504 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 1505 1506 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap; 1507 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap; 1508 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap; 1509 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper; 1510 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap; 1511 const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper; 1512 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required; 1513 bool twt_responder; 1514 u32 flags; 1515 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 1516 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 1517 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; 1518 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config; 1519 }; 1520 1521 1522 /** 1523 * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update 1524 * 1525 * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP. 1526 * 1527 * @beacon: beacon data 1528 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters 1529 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters 1530 */ 1531 struct cfg80211_ap_update { 1532 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; 1533 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 1534 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; 1535 }; 1536 1537 /** 1538 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings 1539 * 1540 * Used for channel switch 1541 * 1542 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch 1543 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch 1544 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1545 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1546 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail) 1547 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response 1548 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel 1549 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel 1550 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing 1551 * @count: number of beacons until switch 1552 * @link_id: defines the link on which channel switch is expected during 1553 * MLO. 0 in case of non-MLO. 1554 */ 1555 struct cfg80211_csa_settings { 1556 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1557 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa; 1558 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon; 1559 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp; 1560 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon; 1561 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp; 1562 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after; 1563 bool radar_required; 1564 bool block_tx; 1565 u8 count; 1566 u8 link_id; 1567 }; 1568 1569 /** 1570 * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings 1571 * 1572 * Used for bss color change 1573 * 1574 * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown 1575 * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1576 * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1577 * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change 1578 * @count: number of beacons until the color change 1579 * @color: the color used after the change 1580 */ 1581 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings { 1582 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change; 1583 u16 counter_offset_beacon; 1584 u16 counter_offset_presp; 1585 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next; 1586 u8 count; 1587 u8 color; 1588 }; 1589 1590 /** 1591 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations 1592 * 1593 * Used to pass interface combination parameters 1594 * 1595 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want 1596 * to use for verification 1597 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel 1598 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of 1599 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths 1600 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface 1601 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum 1602 * nl80211_iftype. 1603 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface 1604 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of 1605 * the verification 1606 */ 1607 struct iface_combination_params { 1608 int num_different_channels; 1609 u8 radar_detect; 1610 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES]; 1611 u32 new_beacon_int; 1612 }; 1613 1614 /** 1615 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply 1616 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp) 1617 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability 1618 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state 1619 * 1620 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling, 1621 * for those that don't these flags will are used. 1622 */ 1623 enum station_parameters_apply_mask { 1624 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0), 1625 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1), 1626 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2), 1627 }; 1628 1629 /** 1630 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 1631 * 1632 * Used to configure txpower for station. 1633 * 1634 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power 1635 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be 1636 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx 1637 * power per-interface or per-station. 1638 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 1639 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 1640 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 1641 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 1642 * per peer TPC. 1643 */ 1644 struct sta_txpwr { 1645 s16 power; 1646 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 1647 }; 1648 1649 /** 1650 * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters 1651 * 1652 * Used to change and create a new link station. 1653 * 1654 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station 1655 * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station) 1656 * @link_mac: MAC address of the link 1657 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1658 * (or NULL for no change) 1659 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates 1660 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station 1661 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station 1662 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification 1663 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used 1664 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station 1665 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities 1666 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station 1667 * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set 1668 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station 1669 * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station 1670 * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities 1671 */ 1672 struct link_station_parameters { 1673 const u8 *mld_mac; 1674 int link_id; 1675 const u8 *link_mac; 1676 const u8 *supported_rates; 1677 u8 supported_rates_len; 1678 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa; 1679 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa; 1680 u8 opmode_notif; 1681 bool opmode_notif_used; 1682 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa; 1683 u8 he_capa_len; 1684 struct sta_txpwr txpwr; 1685 bool txpwr_set; 1686 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa; 1687 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa; 1688 u8 eht_capa_len; 1689 }; 1690 1691 /** 1692 * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters 1693 * 1694 * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations). 1695 * 1696 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station 1697 * @link_id: the link id 1698 */ 1699 struct link_station_del_parameters { 1700 const u8 *mld_mac; 1701 u32 link_id; 1702 }; 1703 1704 /** 1705 * struct cfg80211_ttlm_params: TID to link mapping parameters 1706 * 1707 * Used for setting a TID to link mapping. 1708 * 1709 * @dlink: Downlink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314 1710 * (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0. 1711 * @ulink: Uplink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314 1712 * (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0. 1713 */ 1714 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params { 1715 u16 dlink[8]; 1716 u16 ulink[8]; 1717 }; 1718 1719 /** 1720 * struct station_parameters - station parameters 1721 * 1722 * Used to change and create a new station. 1723 * 1724 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to 1725 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed 1726 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1727 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values 1728 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1729 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change 1730 * @aid: AID or zero for no change 1731 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero) 1732 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change 1733 * @plink_action: plink action to take 1734 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station 1735 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format 1736 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 1737 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the 1738 * QoS info field (but already shifted down) 1739 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed 1740 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value), 1741 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask 1742 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set 1743 * to unknown) 1744 * @capability: station capability 1745 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station 1746 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities 1747 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format 1748 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels 1749 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format 1750 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes 1751 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism 1752 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station 1753 * @link_sta_params: link related params. 1754 */ 1755 struct station_parameters { 1756 struct net_device *vlan; 1757 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set; 1758 u32 sta_modify_mask; 1759 int listen_interval; 1760 u16 aid; 1761 u16 vlan_id; 1762 u16 peer_aid; 1763 u8 plink_action; 1764 u8 plink_state; 1765 u8 uapsd_queues; 1766 u8 max_sp; 1767 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1768 u16 capability; 1769 const u8 *ext_capab; 1770 u8 ext_capab_len; 1771 const u8 *supported_channels; 1772 u8 supported_channels_len; 1773 const u8 *supported_oper_classes; 1774 u8 supported_oper_classes_len; 1775 int support_p2p_ps; 1776 u16 airtime_weight; 1777 struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params; 1778 }; 1779 1780 /** 1781 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters 1782 * 1783 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations). 1784 * 1785 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations 1786 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal 1787 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication) 1788 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame 1789 * @link_id: Link ID indicating a link that stations to be flushed must be 1790 * using; valid only for MLO, but can also be -1 for MLO to really 1791 * remove all stations. 1792 */ 1793 struct station_del_parameters { 1794 const u8 *mac; 1795 u8 subtype; 1796 u16 reason_code; 1797 int link_id; 1798 }; 1799 1800 /** 1801 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified 1802 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface 1803 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still 1804 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted) 1805 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has 1806 * the AP MLME in the device 1807 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface 1808 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station 1809 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry 1810 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when 1811 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is 1812 * supported/used) 1813 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active 1814 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace) 1815 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed) 1816 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed) 1817 */ 1818 enum cfg80211_station_type { 1819 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT, 1820 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC, 1821 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT, 1822 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA, 1823 CFG80211_STA_IBSS, 1824 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP, 1825 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE, 1826 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL, 1827 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER, 1828 }; 1829 1830 /** 1831 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes 1832 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on 1833 * @params: the new parameters for a station 1834 * @statype: the type of station being modified 1835 * 1836 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function 1837 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that 1838 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable. 1839 * 1840 * Return: 0 if the change is acceptable, otherwise an error code. Note that 1841 * it may modify the parameters for backward compatibility reasons, so don't 1842 * use them before calling this. 1843 */ 1844 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1845 struct station_parameters *params, 1846 enum cfg80211_station_type statype); 1847 1848 /** 1849 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags 1850 * 1851 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1852 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1853 * 1854 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS 1855 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS 1856 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 1857 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS 1858 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information 1859 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode 1860 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS 1861 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information 1862 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS 1863 */ 1864 enum rate_info_flags { 1865 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0), 1866 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1), 1867 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1868 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3), 1869 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4), 1870 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5), 1871 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG = BIT(6), 1872 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS = BIT(7), 1873 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS = BIT(8), 1874 }; 1875 1876 /** 1877 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information 1878 * 1879 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth. 1880 * 1881 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth 1882 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth 1883 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth 1884 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth 1885 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth 1886 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth 1887 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation 1888 * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth 1889 * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation 1890 * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth 1891 * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth 1892 * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth 1893 * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth 1894 * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth 1895 */ 1896 enum rate_info_bw { 1897 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0, 1898 RATE_INFO_BW_5, 1899 RATE_INFO_BW_10, 1900 RATE_INFO_BW_40, 1901 RATE_INFO_BW_80, 1902 RATE_INFO_BW_160, 1903 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU, 1904 RATE_INFO_BW_320, 1905 RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU, 1906 RATE_INFO_BW_1, 1907 RATE_INFO_BW_2, 1908 RATE_INFO_BW_4, 1909 RATE_INFO_BW_8, 1910 RATE_INFO_BW_16, 1911 }; 1912 1913 /** 1914 * struct rate_info - bitrate information 1915 * 1916 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate 1917 * 1918 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags 1919 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg 1920 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate 1921 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only) 1922 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw) 1923 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi) 1924 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1925 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc, 1926 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU) 1927 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4) 1928 * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi) 1929 * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc, 1930 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU) 1931 */ 1932 struct rate_info { 1933 u16 flags; 1934 u16 legacy; 1935 u8 mcs; 1936 u8 nss; 1937 u8 bw; 1938 u8 he_gi; 1939 u8 he_dcm; 1940 u8 he_ru_alloc; 1941 u8 n_bonded_ch; 1942 u8 eht_gi; 1943 u8 eht_ru_alloc; 1944 }; 1945 1946 /** 1947 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags 1948 * 1949 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1950 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1951 * 1952 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled 1953 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1954 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 1955 */ 1956 enum bss_param_flags { 1957 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = 1<<0, 1958 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<1, 1959 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = 1<<2, 1960 }; 1961 1962 /** 1963 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station 1964 * 1965 * Information about the currently associated BSS 1966 * 1967 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags 1968 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS 1969 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1970 */ 1971 struct sta_bss_parameters { 1972 u8 flags; 1973 u8 dtim_period; 1974 u16 beacon_interval; 1975 }; 1976 1977 /** 1978 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID 1979 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to 1980 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1981 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged 1982 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged 1983 * @flows: number of new flows seen 1984 * @drops: total number of packets dropped 1985 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE 1986 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow 1987 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 1988 * @collisions: number of hash collisions 1989 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued 1990 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued 1991 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported 1992 */ 1993 struct cfg80211_txq_stats { 1994 u32 filled; 1995 u32 backlog_bytes; 1996 u32 backlog_packets; 1997 u32 flows; 1998 u32 drops; 1999 u32 ecn_marks; 2000 u32 overlimit; 2001 u32 overmemory; 2002 u32 collisions; 2003 u32 tx_bytes; 2004 u32 tx_packets; 2005 u32 max_flows; 2006 }; 2007 2008 /** 2009 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics 2010 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to 2011 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 2012 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs 2013 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs 2014 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for 2015 * transmitted MSDUs 2016 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs 2017 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics 2018 */ 2019 struct cfg80211_tid_stats { 2020 u32 filled; 2021 u64 rx_msdu; 2022 u64 tx_msdu; 2023 u64 tx_msdu_retries; 2024 u64 tx_msdu_failed; 2025 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats; 2026 }; 2027 2028 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4 2029 2030 /** 2031 * struct station_info - station information 2032 * 2033 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station. 2034 * 2035 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to 2036 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 2037 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected 2038 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds 2039 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association 2040 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station 2041 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station 2042 * @llid: mesh local link id 2043 * @plid: mesh peer link id 2044 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state 2045 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 2046 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 2047 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 2048 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 2049 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg 2050 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm 2051 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm 2052 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station 2053 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station 2054 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station 2055 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station 2056 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs) 2057 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK) 2058 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason. 2059 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters 2060 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 2061 * This number should increase every time the list of stations 2062 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 2063 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 2064 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request. 2065 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use 2066 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for 2067 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. 2068 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets. 2069 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values 2070 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered. 2071 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host. 2072 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode 2073 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode 2074 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode 2075 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers) 2076 * towards this station. 2077 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer 2078 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received 2079 * from this peer 2080 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate 2081 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer 2082 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer 2083 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight 2084 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last 2085 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs. 2086 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL. 2087 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame. 2088 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has 2089 * been sent. 2090 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station 2091 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with 2092 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the 2093 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address. 2094 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric. 2095 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server 2096 * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled 2097 * by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP 2098 * MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this 2099 * information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and 2100 * dump_station() callbacks. 2101 * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station 2102 * completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO 2103 * and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. 2104 * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station. 2105 * For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros. 2106 * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response. 2107 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user 2108 * space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the 2109 * cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't 2110 * fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and 2111 * dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine 2112 * the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station. 2113 * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets. 2114 */ 2115 struct station_info { 2116 u64 filled; 2117 u32 connected_time; 2118 u32 inactive_time; 2119 u64 assoc_at; 2120 u64 rx_bytes; 2121 u64 tx_bytes; 2122 u16 llid; 2123 u16 plid; 2124 u8 plink_state; 2125 s8 signal; 2126 s8 signal_avg; 2127 2128 u8 chains; 2129 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2130 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2131 2132 struct rate_info txrate; 2133 struct rate_info rxrate; 2134 u32 rx_packets; 2135 u32 tx_packets; 2136 u32 tx_retries; 2137 u32 tx_failed; 2138 u32 rx_dropped_misc; 2139 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param; 2140 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags; 2141 2142 int generation; 2143 2144 const u8 *assoc_req_ies; 2145 size_t assoc_req_ies_len; 2146 2147 u32 beacon_loss_count; 2148 s64 t_offset; 2149 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 2150 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm; 2151 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm; 2152 2153 u32 expected_throughput; 2154 2155 u64 tx_duration; 2156 u64 rx_duration; 2157 u64 rx_beacon; 2158 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg; 2159 u8 connected_to_gate; 2160 2161 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid; 2162 s8 ack_signal; 2163 s8 avg_ack_signal; 2164 2165 u16 airtime_weight; 2166 2167 u32 rx_mpdu_count; 2168 u32 fcs_err_count; 2169 2170 u32 airtime_link_metric; 2171 2172 u8 connected_to_as; 2173 2174 bool mlo_params_valid; 2175 u8 assoc_link_id; 2176 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2177 const u8 *assoc_resp_ies; 2178 size_t assoc_resp_ies_len; 2179 }; 2180 2181 /** 2182 * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit 2183 * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm 2184 * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to 2185 */ 2186 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs { 2187 s32 power; 2188 u32 freq_range_index; 2189 }; 2190 2191 /** 2192 * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs 2193 * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types 2194 * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs 2195 * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs 2196 */ 2197 struct cfg80211_sar_specs { 2198 enum nl80211_sar_type type; 2199 u32 num_sub_specs; 2200 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[]; 2201 }; 2202 2203 2204 /** 2205 * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges 2206 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency 2207 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency 2208 */ 2209 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges { 2210 u32 start_freq; 2211 u32 end_freq; 2212 }; 2213 2214 /** 2215 * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability 2216 * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types 2217 * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges 2218 * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges. 2219 * 2220 * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing 2221 * range to small ones and then append them. 2222 */ 2223 struct cfg80211_sar_capa { 2224 enum nl80211_sar_type type; 2225 u32 num_freq_ranges; 2226 const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges; 2227 }; 2228 2229 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) 2230 /** 2231 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station 2232 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to 2233 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest 2234 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information 2235 * 2236 * Return: 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information 2237 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be 2238 * considered undefined. 2239 */ 2240 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 2241 struct station_info *sinfo); 2242 #else 2243 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, 2244 const u8 *mac_addr, 2245 struct station_info *sinfo) 2246 { 2247 return -ENOENT; 2248 } 2249 #endif 2250 2251 /** 2252 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags 2253 * 2254 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits 2255 * according to the nl80211 flags. 2256 * 2257 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed 2258 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 2259 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 2260 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 2261 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 2262 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing 2263 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address 2264 */ 2265 enum monitor_flags { 2266 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 2267 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 2268 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 2269 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 2270 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 2271 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 2272 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 2273 }; 2274 2275 /** 2276 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags 2277 * 2278 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled 2279 * in during get_station() or dump_station(). 2280 * 2281 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled 2282 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled 2283 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled 2284 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled 2285 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled 2286 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled 2287 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled 2288 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled 2289 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled 2290 */ 2291 enum mpath_info_flags { 2292 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0), 2293 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1), 2294 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2), 2295 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3), 2296 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4), 2297 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5), 2298 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6), 2299 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7), 2300 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8), 2301 }; 2302 2303 /** 2304 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information 2305 * 2306 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath(). 2307 * 2308 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags 2309 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination 2310 * @sn: target sequence number 2311 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path 2312 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs 2313 * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags 2314 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs 2315 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries 2316 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 2317 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths 2318 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 2319 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 2320 * @hop_count: hops to destination 2321 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination 2322 */ 2323 struct mpath_info { 2324 u32 filled; 2325 u32 frame_qlen; 2326 u32 sn; 2327 u32 metric; 2328 u32 exptime; 2329 u32 discovery_timeout; 2330 u8 discovery_retries; 2331 u8 flags; 2332 u8 hop_count; 2333 u32 path_change_count; 2334 2335 int generation; 2336 }; 2337 2338 /** 2339 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters 2340 * 2341 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode). 2342 * 2343 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD 2344 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection 2345 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 2346 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed 2347 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 2348 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed 2349 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 2350 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format 2351 * (or NULL for no change) 2352 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates 2353 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations 2354 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 2355 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode 2356 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change) 2357 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change) 2358 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change) 2359 */ 2360 struct bss_parameters { 2361 int link_id; 2362 int use_cts_prot; 2363 int use_short_preamble; 2364 int use_short_slot_time; 2365 const u8 *basic_rates; 2366 u8 basic_rates_len; 2367 int ap_isolate; 2368 int ht_opmode; 2369 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps; 2370 }; 2371 2372 /** 2373 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration 2374 * 2375 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active. 2376 * 2377 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used 2378 * by the Mesh Peering Open message 2379 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units 2380 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message 2381 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by 2382 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering 2383 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this 2384 * mesh interface 2385 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can 2386 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh 2387 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA 2388 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection 2389 * elements 2390 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we 2391 * detect compatible mesh peers 2392 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to 2393 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 2394 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ 2395 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target 2396 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds 2397 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on 2398 * a path discovery in milliseconds 2399 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 2400 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the 2401 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 2402 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 2403 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 2404 * element 2405 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 2406 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR 2407 * element 2408 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that 2409 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh 2410 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA 2411 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root 2412 * announcements are transmitted 2413 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh 2414 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is 2415 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true 2416 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but 2417 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the 2418 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec) 2419 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding 2420 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 2421 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate 2422 * station to establish a peer link 2423 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode 2424 * 2425 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 2426 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to 2427 * the root mesh STA to be valid. 2428 * 2429 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive 2430 * PREQs are transmitted. 2431 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs) 2432 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing 2433 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 2434 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial 2435 * setting for new peer links. 2436 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake 2437 * after transmitting its beacon. 2438 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established 2439 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it 2440 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes. 2441 * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA 2442 * will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server 2443 * in the mesh formation field. 2444 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is 2445 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the 2446 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths 2447 * in the mesh path table 2448 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP 2449 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might 2450 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So 2451 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable 2452 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. 2453 */ 2454 struct mesh_config { 2455 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout; 2456 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout; 2457 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout; 2458 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks; 2459 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries; 2460 u8 dot11MeshTTL; 2461 u8 element_ttl; 2462 bool auto_open_plinks; 2463 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor; 2464 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries; 2465 u32 path_refresh_time; 2466 u16 min_discovery_timeout; 2467 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout; 2468 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval; 2469 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval; 2470 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime; 2471 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode; 2472 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate; 2473 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer; 2474 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval; 2475 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol; 2476 bool dot11MeshForwarding; 2477 s32 rssi_threshold; 2478 u16 ht_opmode; 2479 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout; 2480 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval; 2481 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval; 2482 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode; 2483 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration; 2484 u32 plink_timeout; 2485 bool dot11MeshNolearn; 2486 }; 2487 2488 /** 2489 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration 2490 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2491 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID 2492 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes 2493 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use 2494 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use 2495 * @path_metric: which metric to use 2496 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using 2497 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional) 2498 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements 2499 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication 2500 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security 2501 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions 2502 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use 2503 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2504 * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a] 2505 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh 2506 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 2507 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2508 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2509 * to operate on DFS channels. 2510 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2511 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2512 * 2513 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created. 2514 */ 2515 struct mesh_setup { 2516 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2517 const u8 *mesh_id; 2518 u8 mesh_id_len; 2519 u8 sync_method; 2520 u8 path_sel_proto; 2521 u8 path_metric; 2522 u8 auth_id; 2523 const u8 *ie; 2524 u8 ie_len; 2525 bool is_authenticated; 2526 bool is_secure; 2527 bool user_mpm; 2528 u8 dtim_period; 2529 u16 beacon_interval; 2530 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2531 u32 basic_rates; 2532 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 2533 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2534 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2535 }; 2536 2537 /** 2538 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration 2539 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2540 * 2541 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network 2542 */ 2543 struct ocb_setup { 2544 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2545 }; 2546 2547 /** 2548 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters 2549 * @ac: AC identifier 2550 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 2551 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2552 * 1..32767] 2553 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2554 * 1..32767] 2555 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 2556 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD 2557 */ 2558 struct ieee80211_txq_params { 2559 enum nl80211_ac ac; 2560 u16 txop; 2561 u16 cwmin; 2562 u16 cwmax; 2563 u8 aifs; 2564 int link_id; 2565 }; 2566 2567 /** 2568 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling 2569 * 2570 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite 2571 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will 2572 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the 2573 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the 2574 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to 2575 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements 2576 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be 2577 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised 2578 * in the wiphy structure. 2579 * 2580 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because 2581 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not 2582 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist. 2583 * 2584 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of 2585 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the 2586 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available 2587 * to userspace. 2588 */ 2589 2590 /** 2591 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description 2592 * @ssid: the SSID 2593 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid 2594 */ 2595 struct cfg80211_ssid { 2596 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 2597 u8 ssid_len; 2598 }; 2599 2600 /** 2601 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan 2602 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the 2603 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this 2604 * information is not available, this field is left zero. 2605 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set. 2606 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason, 2607 * userspace will be notified of that 2608 */ 2609 struct cfg80211_scan_info { 2610 u64 scan_start_tsf; 2611 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2612 bool aborted; 2613 }; 2614 2615 /** 2616 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only 2617 * 2618 * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for 2619 * @bssid: bssid to scan for 2620 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request 2621 * which the above info is relevant to 2622 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU 2623 * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used 2624 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait 2625 * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests. 2626 * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value. 2627 */ 2628 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params { 2629 u32 short_ssid; 2630 u32 channel_idx; 2631 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2632 bool unsolicited_probe; 2633 bool short_ssid_valid; 2634 bool psc_no_listen; 2635 s8 psd_20; 2636 }; 2637 2638 /** 2639 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description 2640 * 2641 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only) 2642 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2643 * @channels: channels to scan on. 2644 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2645 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2646 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2647 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If 2648 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and 2649 * the actual dwell time may be shorter. 2650 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the 2651 * %duration field. 2652 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags 2653 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band 2654 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2655 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started 2656 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for 2657 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan 2658 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted 2659 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band 2660 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2661 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2662 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2663 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2664 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only, 2665 * true if this is the second scan request 2666 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params 2667 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params 2668 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID) 2669 * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be 2670 * used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference. 2671 */ 2672 struct cfg80211_scan_request { 2673 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2674 int n_ssids; 2675 u32 n_channels; 2676 const u8 *ie; 2677 size_t ie_len; 2678 u16 duration; 2679 bool duration_mandatory; 2680 u32 flags; 2681 2682 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2683 2684 struct wireless_dev *wdev; 2685 2686 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2687 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2688 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2689 2690 /* internal */ 2691 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2692 unsigned long scan_start; 2693 struct cfg80211_scan_info info; 2694 bool notified; 2695 bool no_cck; 2696 bool scan_6ghz; 2697 u32 n_6ghz_params; 2698 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params; 2699 s8 tsf_report_link_id; 2700 2701 /* keep last */ 2702 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels); 2703 }; 2704 2705 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask) 2706 { 2707 int i; 2708 2709 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN); 2710 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) { 2711 buf[i] &= ~mask[i]; 2712 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i]; 2713 } 2714 } 2715 2716 /** 2717 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match 2718 * 2719 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match 2720 * or no match (RSSI only) 2721 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match 2722 * or no match (RSSI only) 2723 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm) 2724 */ 2725 struct cfg80211_match_set { 2726 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 2727 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2728 s32 rssi_thold; 2729 }; 2730 2731 /** 2732 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan 2733 * 2734 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds. 2735 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means 2736 * infinite loop. 2737 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero, 2738 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations. 2739 */ 2740 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan { 2741 u32 interval; 2742 u32 iterations; 2743 }; 2744 2745 /** 2746 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment. 2747 * 2748 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment. 2749 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment. 2750 */ 2751 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust { 2752 enum nl80211_band band; 2753 s8 delta; 2754 }; 2755 2756 /** 2757 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description 2758 * 2759 * @reqid: identifies this request. 2760 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans) 2761 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2762 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2763 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2764 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2765 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags 2766 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result 2767 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host 2768 * (others are filtered out). 2769 * If omitted, all results are passed. 2770 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets 2771 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request 2772 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2773 * @dev: the interface 2774 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan 2775 * @channels: channels to scan 2776 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this 2777 * contains the minimum over all matchsets 2778 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2779 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2780 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2781 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2782 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest 2783 * index must be executed first. 2784 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1. 2785 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct 2786 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request 2787 * owned by a particular socket) 2788 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed 2789 * @list: for keeping list of requests. 2790 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan 2791 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start 2792 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not 2793 * supported. 2794 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not. 2795 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result 2796 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined 2797 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS. 2798 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state. 2799 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong 2800 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported 2801 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that 2802 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative 2803 * comparisons. 2804 */ 2805 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request { 2806 u64 reqid; 2807 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2808 int n_ssids; 2809 u32 n_channels; 2810 const u8 *ie; 2811 size_t ie_len; 2812 u32 flags; 2813 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets; 2814 int n_match_sets; 2815 s32 min_rssi_thold; 2816 u32 delay; 2817 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans; 2818 int n_scan_plans; 2819 2820 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2821 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2822 2823 bool relative_rssi_set; 2824 s8 relative_rssi; 2825 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust; 2826 2827 /* internal */ 2828 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2829 struct net_device *dev; 2830 unsigned long scan_start; 2831 bool report_results; 2832 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2833 u32 owner_nlportid; 2834 bool nl_owner_dead; 2835 struct list_head list; 2836 2837 /* keep last */ 2838 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2839 }; 2840 2841 /** 2842 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type 2843 * 2844 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available 2845 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm) 2846 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100 2847 */ 2848 enum cfg80211_signal_type { 2849 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE, 2850 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, 2851 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC, 2852 }; 2853 2854 /** 2855 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data 2856 * @chan: channel the frame was received on 2857 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's 2858 * signal type 2859 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was 2860 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually 2861 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was 2862 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms. 2863 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of 2864 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate. 2865 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the 2866 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified 2867 * by %parent_bssid. 2868 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to 2869 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received. 2870 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2871 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2872 * @restrict_use: restrict usage, if not set, assume @use_for is 2873 * %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL. 2874 * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see 2875 * &enum nl80211_bss_use_for 2876 * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect, 2877 * if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for 2878 * unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons 2879 * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss 2880 */ 2881 struct cfg80211_inform_bss { 2882 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 2883 s32 signal; 2884 u64 boottime_ns; 2885 u64 parent_tsf; 2886 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2887 u8 chains; 2888 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2889 2890 u8 restrict_use:1, use_for:7; 2891 u8 cannot_use_reasons; 2892 2893 void *drv_data; 2894 }; 2895 2896 /** 2897 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data 2898 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs 2899 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing 2900 * @len: length of the IEs 2901 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon 2902 * @data: IE data 2903 */ 2904 struct cfg80211_bss_ies { 2905 u64 tsf; 2906 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2907 int len; 2908 bool from_beacon; 2909 u8 data[]; 2910 }; 2911 2912 /** 2913 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description 2914 * 2915 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network) 2916 * for use in scan results and similar. 2917 * 2918 * @channel: channel this BSS is on 2919 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS 2920 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame 2921 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order 2922 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these 2923 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or 2924 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been 2925 * received. It is always non-%NULL. 2926 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame 2927 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't 2928 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the 2929 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct) 2930 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame 2931 * @proberesp_ecsa_stuck: ECSA element is stuck in the Probe Response frame, 2932 * cannot rely on it having valid data 2933 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from 2934 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct 2935 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and 2936 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case. 2937 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a 2938 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support) 2939 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one 2940 * (multi-BSSID support) 2941 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type) 2942 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2943 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2944 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set 2945 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set 2946 * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see 2947 * &enum nl80211_bss_use_for 2948 * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect, 2949 * if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for 2950 * unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons 2951 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes 2952 */ 2953 struct cfg80211_bss { 2954 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2955 2956 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies; 2957 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies; 2958 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies; 2959 2960 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss; 2961 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss; 2962 struct list_head nontrans_list; 2963 2964 s32 signal; 2965 2966 u16 beacon_interval; 2967 u16 capability; 2968 2969 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2970 u8 chains; 2971 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2972 2973 u8 proberesp_ecsa_stuck:1; 2974 2975 u8 bssid_index; 2976 u8 max_bssid_indicator; 2977 2978 u8 use_for; 2979 u8 cannot_use_reasons; 2980 2981 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2982 }; 2983 2984 /** 2985 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID 2986 * @bss: the bss to search 2987 * @id: the element ID 2988 * 2989 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2990 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2991 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2992 */ 2993 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id); 2994 2995 /** 2996 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID 2997 * @bss: the bss to search 2998 * @id: the element ID 2999 * 3000 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 3001 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 3002 * Return: %NULL if not found. 3003 */ 3004 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id) 3005 { 3006 return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id); 3007 } 3008 3009 3010 /** 3011 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data 3012 * 3013 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3014 * authentication. 3015 * 3016 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference 3017 * to it if it needs to keep it. 3018 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 3019 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL 3020 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 3021 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 3022 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 3023 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 3024 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains 3025 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the 3026 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication 3027 * transaction sequence number field. 3028 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets 3029 * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD, 3030 * the interface address is included as the MLD address and the 3031 * necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and 3032 * given an MLD address) by the driver 3033 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with 3034 * an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0 3035 */ 3036 struct cfg80211_auth_request { 3037 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 3038 const u8 *ie; 3039 size_t ie_len; 3040 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 3041 const u8 *key; 3042 u8 key_len; 3043 s8 key_idx; 3044 const u8 *auth_data; 3045 size_t auth_data_len; 3046 s8 link_id; 3047 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 3048 }; 3049 3050 /** 3051 * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association 3052 * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss; 3053 * if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested 3054 * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link 3055 * @elems_len: length of the elements 3056 * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it 3057 * should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD. 3058 * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the 3059 * operation as a whole must fail. 3060 */ 3061 struct cfg80211_assoc_link { 3062 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 3063 const u8 *elems; 3064 size_t elems_len; 3065 bool disabled; 3066 int error; 3067 }; 3068 3069 /** 3070 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association. 3071 * 3072 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n) 3073 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT 3074 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association 3075 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external 3076 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to 3077 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect() 3078 * request (connect callback). 3079 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE: Disable HE 3080 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT: Disable EHT 3081 * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links. 3082 * Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this 3083 * flag is not set. 3084 * @ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs will be used on this connection (if any) 3085 */ 3086 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags { 3087 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0), 3088 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1), 3089 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2), 3090 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3), 3091 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE = BIT(4), 3092 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT = BIT(5), 3093 CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT = BIT(6), 3094 ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(7), 3095 }; 3096 3097 /** 3098 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data 3099 * 3100 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3101 * (re)association. 3102 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is 3103 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc() 3104 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new 3105 * association requests while already associating must be rejected. 3106 * This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead 3107 * of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations. 3108 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL 3109 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 3110 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association 3111 * @crypto: crypto settings 3112 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 3113 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 3114 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 3115 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 3116 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 3117 * frame. 3118 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 3119 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 3120 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 3121 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 3122 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override 3123 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use 3124 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or 3125 * %NULL if FILS is not used. 3126 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets 3127 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association 3128 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts 3129 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 3130 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override 3131 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask 3132 * @links: per-link information for MLO connections 3133 * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates 3134 * the link on which the association request should be sent 3135 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request, 3136 * valid iff @link_id >= 0 3137 */ 3138 struct cfg80211_assoc_request { 3139 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 3140 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid; 3141 size_t ie_len; 3142 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 3143 bool use_mfp; 3144 u32 flags; 3145 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 3146 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 3147 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask; 3148 const u8 *fils_kek; 3149 size_t fils_kek_len; 3150 const u8 *fils_nonces; 3151 struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask; 3152 struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 3153 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 3154 s8 link_id; 3155 }; 3156 3157 /** 3158 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data 3159 * 3160 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3161 * deauthentication. 3162 * 3163 * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from 3164 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL 3165 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 3166 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication 3167 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and 3168 * do not set a deauth frame 3169 */ 3170 struct cfg80211_deauth_request { 3171 const u8 *bssid; 3172 const u8 *ie; 3173 size_t ie_len; 3174 u16 reason_code; 3175 bool local_state_change; 3176 }; 3177 3178 /** 3179 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data 3180 * 3181 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3182 * disassociation. 3183 * 3184 * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from 3185 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL 3186 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 3187 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation 3188 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no 3189 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted. 3190 */ 3191 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request { 3192 const u8 *ap_addr; 3193 const u8 *ie; 3194 size_t ie_len; 3195 u16 reason_code; 3196 bool local_state_change; 3197 }; 3198 3199 /** 3200 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters 3201 * 3202 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss() 3203 * method. 3204 * 3205 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null. 3206 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero. 3207 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not 3208 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID. 3209 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found 3210 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for 3211 * IBSSs to join on other channels. 3212 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon 3213 * @ie_len: length of that 3214 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 3215 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured 3216 * after joining 3217 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 3218 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 3219 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 3220 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 3221 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 3222 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 3223 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 3224 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 3225 * to operate on DFS channels. 3226 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS 3227 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 3228 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 3229 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 3230 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 3231 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 3232 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 3233 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 3234 */ 3235 struct cfg80211_ibss_params { 3236 const u8 *ssid; 3237 const u8 *bssid; 3238 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 3239 const u8 *ie; 3240 u8 ssid_len, ie_len; 3241 u16 beacon_interval; 3242 u32 basic_rates; 3243 bool channel_fixed; 3244 bool privacy; 3245 bool control_port; 3246 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 3247 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 3248 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 3249 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 3250 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 3251 struct key_params *wep_keys; 3252 int wep_tx_key; 3253 }; 3254 3255 /** 3256 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection. 3257 * 3258 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour. 3259 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour. 3260 * @param.band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF. 3261 * @param.adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST. 3262 */ 3263 struct cfg80211_bss_selection { 3264 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour; 3265 union { 3266 enum nl80211_band band_pref; 3267 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust; 3268 } param; 3269 }; 3270 3271 /** 3272 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters 3273 * 3274 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3275 * authentication and association. 3276 * 3277 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based 3278 * on scan results) 3279 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or 3280 * %NULL if not specified 3281 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan 3282 * results) 3283 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or 3284 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is 3285 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS 3286 * to use. 3287 * @ssid: SSID 3288 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets 3289 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 3290 * @ie: IEs for association request 3291 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets 3292 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used 3293 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used 3294 * @crypto: crypto settings 3295 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 3296 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 3297 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 3298 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 3299 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds 3300 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used. 3301 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 3302 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 3303 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 3304 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides 3305 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used. 3306 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG 3307 * networks. 3308 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection. 3309 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 3310 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 3311 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 3312 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 3313 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 3314 * frame. 3315 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the 3316 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped 3317 * data IE. 3318 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets. 3319 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or 3320 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and 3321 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 3322 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets. 3323 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP 3324 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 3325 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional 3326 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified. 3327 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets. 3328 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver 3329 * offload of 4-way handshake. 3330 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels. 3331 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver 3332 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration. 3333 */ 3334 struct cfg80211_connect_params { 3335 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 3336 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint; 3337 const u8 *bssid; 3338 const u8 *bssid_hint; 3339 const u8 *ssid; 3340 size_t ssid_len; 3341 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 3342 const u8 *ie; 3343 size_t ie_len; 3344 bool privacy; 3345 enum nl80211_mfp mfp; 3346 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 3347 const u8 *key; 3348 u8 key_len, key_idx; 3349 u32 flags; 3350 int bg_scan_period; 3351 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 3352 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 3353 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa; 3354 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask; 3355 bool pbss; 3356 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select; 3357 const u8 *prev_bssid; 3358 const u8 *fils_erp_username; 3359 size_t fils_erp_username_len; 3360 const u8 *fils_erp_realm; 3361 size_t fils_erp_realm_len; 3362 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num; 3363 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk; 3364 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len; 3365 bool want_1x; 3366 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 3367 }; 3368 3369 /** 3370 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated 3371 * 3372 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that 3373 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call. 3374 * 3375 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated 3376 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm, 3377 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated 3378 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated 3379 */ 3380 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed { 3381 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0), 3382 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1), 3383 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2), 3384 }; 3385 3386 /** 3387 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values 3388 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed 3389 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed 3390 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed 3391 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed 3392 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed 3393 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled 3394 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed 3395 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed 3396 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum 3397 */ 3398 enum wiphy_params_flags { 3399 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = 1 << 0, 3400 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = 1 << 1, 3401 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = 1 << 2, 3402 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = 1 << 3, 3403 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = 1 << 4, 3404 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = 1 << 5, 3405 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = 1 << 6, 3406 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = 1 << 7, 3407 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = 1 << 8, 3408 }; 3409 3410 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256 3411 3412 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */ 3413 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000 3414 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000 3415 3416 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */ 3417 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000 3418 3419 /** 3420 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association 3421 * 3422 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA 3423 * caching. 3424 * 3425 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL). 3426 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 3427 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key 3428 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL. 3429 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on 3430 * the hash algorithm used to generate this. 3431 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS 3432 * cache identifier (may be %NULL). 3433 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets. 3434 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the 3435 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be 3436 * %NULL). 3437 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds 3438 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified. 3439 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after 3440 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on 3441 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK 3442 * used for it expires. 3443 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of 3444 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified. 3445 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using 3446 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this 3447 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires. 3448 */ 3449 struct cfg80211_pmksa { 3450 const u8 *bssid; 3451 const u8 *pmkid; 3452 const u8 *pmk; 3453 size_t pmk_len; 3454 const u8 *ssid; 3455 size_t ssid_len; 3456 const u8 *cache_id; 3457 u32 pmk_lifetime; 3458 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold; 3459 }; 3460 3461 /** 3462 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern 3463 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes, 3464 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211 3465 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1 3466 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes) 3467 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes) 3468 * 3469 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of 3470 * memory, free @mask only! 3471 */ 3472 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern { 3473 const u8 *mask, *pattern; 3474 int pattern_len; 3475 int pkt_offset; 3476 }; 3477 3478 /** 3479 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters 3480 * 3481 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation 3482 * @src: source IP address 3483 * @dst: destination IP address 3484 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address 3485 * @src_port: source port 3486 * @dst_port: destination port 3487 * @payload_len: data payload length 3488 * @payload: data payload buffer 3489 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration 3490 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets 3491 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length 3492 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data 3493 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask 3494 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer 3495 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration 3496 */ 3497 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp { 3498 struct socket *sock; 3499 __be32 src, dst; 3500 u16 src_port, dst_port; 3501 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN]; 3502 int payload_len; 3503 const u8 *payload; 3504 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq; 3505 u32 data_interval; 3506 u32 wake_len; 3507 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask; 3508 u32 tokens_size; 3509 /* must be last, variable member */ 3510 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok; 3511 }; 3512 3513 /** 3514 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info 3515 * 3516 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device. 3517 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues 3518 * operating as normal during suspend 3519 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected 3520 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet 3521 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern 3522 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 3523 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure 3524 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet 3525 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake 3526 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released 3527 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h. 3528 * NULL if not configured. 3529 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake. 3530 */ 3531 struct cfg80211_wowlan { 3532 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3533 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3534 rfkill_release; 3535 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 3536 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp; 3537 int n_patterns; 3538 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config; 3539 }; 3540 3541 /** 3542 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters 3543 * 3544 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device. 3545 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs. 3546 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence. 3547 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 3548 * @patterns: array of packet patterns 3549 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 3550 */ 3551 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules { 3552 int delay; 3553 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition; 3554 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 3555 int n_patterns; 3556 }; 3557 3558 /** 3559 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings 3560 * 3561 * This structure defines coalescing settings. 3562 * @rules: array of coalesce rules 3563 * @n_rules: number of rules 3564 */ 3565 struct cfg80211_coalesce { 3566 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules; 3567 int n_rules; 3568 }; 3569 3570 /** 3571 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match 3572 * 3573 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up 3574 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This 3575 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels. 3576 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match 3577 * occurred (in MHz) 3578 */ 3579 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match { 3580 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3581 int n_channels; 3582 u32 channels[]; 3583 }; 3584 3585 /** 3586 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information 3587 * 3588 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in 3589 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide 3590 * match information. 3591 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about 3592 * the matches that triggered the wake up. 3593 */ 3594 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info { 3595 int n_matches; 3596 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[]; 3597 }; 3598 3599 /** 3600 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report 3601 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected 3602 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet 3603 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure 3604 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet 3605 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake 3606 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released 3607 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern 3608 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data 3609 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length 3610 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any. 3611 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data 3612 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for 3613 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which 3614 * it is. 3615 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received 3616 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish 3617 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens 3618 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect 3619 * @unprot_deauth_disassoc: woke up due to unprotected deauth or 3620 * disassoc frame (in MFP). 3621 */ 3622 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup { 3623 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3624 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3625 rfkill_release, packet_80211, 3626 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens, 3627 unprot_deauth_disassoc; 3628 s32 pattern_idx; 3629 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len; 3630 const void *packet; 3631 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect; 3632 }; 3633 3634 /** 3635 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data 3636 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes) 3637 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes) 3638 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes) 3639 * @kek_len: length of kek 3640 * @kck_len: length of kck 3641 * @akm: akm (oui, id) 3642 */ 3643 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data { 3644 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr; 3645 u32 akm; 3646 u8 kek_len, kck_len; 3647 }; 3648 3649 /** 3650 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information 3651 * 3652 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE 3653 * 3654 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value 3655 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs 3656 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets 3657 */ 3658 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params { 3659 u16 md; 3660 const u8 *ie; 3661 size_t ie_len; 3662 }; 3663 3664 /** 3665 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters 3666 * 3667 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame 3668 * 3669 * @chan: channel to use 3670 * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required 3671 * @wait: duration for ROC 3672 * @buf: buffer to transmit 3673 * @len: buffer length 3674 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame 3675 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack 3676 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array 3677 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame 3678 * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note 3679 * that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the 3680 * link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA) 3681 */ 3682 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params { 3683 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 3684 bool offchan; 3685 unsigned int wait; 3686 const u8 *buf; 3687 size_t len; 3688 bool no_cck; 3689 bool dont_wait_for_ack; 3690 int n_csa_offsets; 3691 const u16 *csa_offsets; 3692 int link_id; 3693 }; 3694 3695 /** 3696 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception 3697 * 3698 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition 3699 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs 3700 */ 3701 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception { 3702 u8 dscp; 3703 u8 up; 3704 }; 3705 3706 /** 3707 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority 3708 * 3709 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3710 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3711 */ 3712 struct cfg80211_dscp_range { 3713 u8 low; 3714 u8 high; 3715 }; 3716 3717 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */ 3718 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21 3719 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16 3720 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \ 3721 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX) 3722 3723 /** 3724 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information 3725 * 3726 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values 3727 * 3728 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21) 3729 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from 3730 * the user priority DSCP range definition 3731 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority 3732 */ 3733 struct cfg80211_qos_map { 3734 u8 num_des; 3735 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX]; 3736 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8]; 3737 }; 3738 3739 /** 3740 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration 3741 * 3742 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters 3743 * 3744 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255) 3745 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. 3746 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 3747 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 3748 */ 3749 struct cfg80211_nan_conf { 3750 u8 master_pref; 3751 u8 bands; 3752 }; 3753 3754 /** 3755 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN 3756 * configuration 3757 * 3758 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference 3759 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands 3760 */ 3761 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes { 3762 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0), 3763 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1), 3764 }; 3765 3766 /** 3767 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter 3768 * 3769 * @filter: the content of the filter 3770 * @len: the length of the filter 3771 */ 3772 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter { 3773 const u8 *filter; 3774 u8 len; 3775 }; 3776 3777 /** 3778 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function 3779 * 3780 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type 3781 * @service_id: the service ID of the function 3782 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type 3783 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is 3784 * implementation specific. 3785 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted 3786 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active 3787 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up 3788 * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up 3789 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up 3790 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW. 3791 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info 3792 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length 3793 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive 3794 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter 3795 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length 3796 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index 3797 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses 3798 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF 3799 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter 3800 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF. 3801 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters. 3802 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters. 3803 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function. 3804 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier. 3805 */ 3806 struct cfg80211_nan_func { 3807 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 3808 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN]; 3809 u8 publish_type; 3810 bool close_range; 3811 bool publish_bcast; 3812 bool subscribe_active; 3813 u8 followup_id; 3814 u8 followup_reqid; 3815 struct mac_address followup_dest; 3816 u32 ttl; 3817 const u8 *serv_spec_info; 3818 u8 serv_spec_info_len; 3819 bool srf_include; 3820 const u8 *srf_bf; 3821 u8 srf_bf_len; 3822 u8 srf_bf_idx; 3823 struct mac_address *srf_macs; 3824 int srf_num_macs; 3825 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters; 3826 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters; 3827 u8 num_tx_filters; 3828 u8 num_rx_filters; 3829 u8 instance_id; 3830 u64 cookie; 3831 }; 3832 3833 /** 3834 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration 3835 * 3836 * @aa: authenticator address 3837 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes. 3838 * @pmk: the PMK material 3839 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK 3840 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field 3841 * holds PMK-R0. 3842 */ 3843 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf { 3844 const u8 *aa; 3845 u8 pmk_len; 3846 const u8 *pmk; 3847 const u8 *pmk_r0_name; 3848 }; 3849 3850 /** 3851 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication. 3852 * 3853 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces. 3854 * 3855 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant 3856 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space). 3857 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has 3858 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and 3859 * authentication response command interface. 3860 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and 3861 * authentication response command interface. 3862 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the 3863 * authentication request event interface. 3864 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication, 3865 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you 3866 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication 3867 * response command interface (user space to driver). 3868 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 3869 * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event 3870 * interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication 3871 * offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT 3872 * flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space 3873 * supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload. 3874 * User space should use the address of the interface (on which the 3875 * authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space 3876 * and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of 3877 * authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver 3878 * translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link 3879 * chosen for the authentication. 3880 */ 3881 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params { 3882 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action; 3883 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3884 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3885 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite; 3886 u16 status; 3887 const u8 *pmkid; 3888 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3889 }; 3890 3891 /** 3892 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics 3893 * 3894 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to 3895 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 3896 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully 3897 * answered 3898 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were 3899 * successfully answered 3900 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions 3901 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions 3902 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions 3903 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication 3904 * of how much time the responder was busy 3905 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from 3906 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with 3907 * the responder 3908 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks 3909 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot 3910 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window 3911 */ 3912 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats { 3913 u32 filled; 3914 u32 success_num; 3915 u32 partial_num; 3916 u32 failed_num; 3917 u32 asap_num; 3918 u32 non_asap_num; 3919 u64 total_duration_ms; 3920 u32 unknown_triggers_num; 3921 u32 reschedule_requests_num; 3922 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num; 3923 }; 3924 3925 /** 3926 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result 3927 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is 3928 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise 3929 * reason than just "failure" 3930 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index 3931 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported 3932 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted 3933 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked 3934 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, 3935 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible 3936 * by the responder 3937 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated 3938 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated 3939 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated 3940 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present) 3941 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present) 3942 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL) 3943 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL) 3944 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3945 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3946 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response 3947 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame 3948 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg) 3949 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is 3950 * the square root of the variance) 3951 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured 3952 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured 3953 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg) 3954 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance) 3955 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread) 3956 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid 3957 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid 3958 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid 3959 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid 3960 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid 3961 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid 3962 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid 3963 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid 3964 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid 3965 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid 3966 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid 3967 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid 3968 */ 3969 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result { 3970 const u8 *lci; 3971 const u8 *civicloc; 3972 unsigned int lci_len; 3973 unsigned int civicloc_len; 3974 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason; 3975 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes; 3976 s16 burst_index; 3977 u8 busy_retry_time; 3978 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3979 u8 burst_duration; 3980 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3981 s32 rssi_avg; 3982 s32 rssi_spread; 3983 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate; 3984 s64 rtt_avg; 3985 s64 rtt_variance; 3986 s64 rtt_spread; 3987 s64 dist_avg; 3988 s64 dist_variance; 3989 s64 dist_spread; 3990 3991 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1, 3992 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1, 3993 rssi_avg_valid:1, 3994 rssi_spread_valid:1, 3995 tx_rate_valid:1, 3996 rx_rate_valid:1, 3997 rtt_avg_valid:1, 3998 rtt_variance_valid:1, 3999 rtt_spread_valid:1, 4000 dist_avg_valid:1, 4001 dist_variance_valid:1, 4002 dist_spread_valid:1; 4003 }; 4004 4005 /** 4006 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result 4007 * @addr: address of the peer 4008 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the 4009 * measurement was made) 4010 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time 4011 * @status: status of the measurement 4012 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not 4013 * reporting partial results always set this flag 4014 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid 4015 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting 4016 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and 4017 * they're all aggregated for userspace. 4018 * @ftm: FTM result 4019 */ 4020 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result { 4021 u64 host_time, ap_tsf; 4022 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status; 4023 4024 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 4025 4026 u8 final:1, 4027 ap_tsf_valid:1; 4028 4029 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type; 4030 4031 union { 4032 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm; 4033 }; 4034 }; 4035 4036 /** 4037 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data 4038 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested 4039 * @preamble: frame preamble to use 4040 * @burst_period: burst period to use 4041 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode 4042 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent 4043 * @burst_duration: burst duration 4044 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst 4045 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request 4046 * @request_lci: request LCI information 4047 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information 4048 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement 4049 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 4050 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 4051 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement 4052 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 4053 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 4054 * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either 4055 * @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set. 4056 * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to 4057 * indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if 4058 * @non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set. 4059 * 4060 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation. 4061 */ 4062 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer { 4063 enum nl80211_preamble preamble; 4064 u16 burst_period; 4065 u8 requested:1, 4066 asap:1, 4067 request_lci:1, 4068 request_civicloc:1, 4069 trigger_based:1, 4070 non_trigger_based:1, 4071 lmr_feedback:1; 4072 u8 num_bursts_exp; 4073 u8 burst_duration; 4074 u8 ftms_per_burst; 4075 u8 ftmr_retries; 4076 u8 bss_color; 4077 }; 4078 4079 /** 4080 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request 4081 * @addr: MAC address 4082 * @chandef: channel to use 4083 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF 4084 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer 4085 */ 4086 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer { 4087 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 4088 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 4089 u8 report_ap_tsf:1; 4090 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm; 4091 }; 4092 4093 /** 4094 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request 4095 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211 4096 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211 4097 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting, 4098 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211 4099 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request 4100 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that 4101 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 4102 * be taken from the @mac_addr 4103 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request 4104 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if 4105 * zero it means there's no timeout 4106 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with 4107 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data 4108 */ 4109 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request { 4110 u64 cookie; 4111 void *drv_data; 4112 u32 n_peers; 4113 u32 nl_portid; 4114 4115 u32 timeout; 4116 4117 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 4118 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 4119 4120 struct list_head list; 4121 4122 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers); 4123 }; 4124 4125 /** 4126 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information 4127 * 4128 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE 4129 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space. 4130 * 4131 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces. 4132 * 4133 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing 4134 * has to be done. 4135 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info 4136 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space 4137 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for 4138 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver). 4139 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are 4140 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and 4141 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface. 4142 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets. 4143 * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested 4144 * by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station 4145 * connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it 4146 * will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space). 4147 * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO 4148 * connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when 4149 * @assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only 4150 * with OWE update event (driver to user space). 4151 */ 4152 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info { 4153 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 4154 u16 status; 4155 const u8 *ie; 4156 size_t ie_len; 4157 int assoc_link_id; 4158 u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 4159 }; 4160 4161 /** 4162 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data 4163 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 4164 * for the entire device 4165 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 4166 * for the given interface 4167 * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes 4168 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface 4169 * for these subtypes 4170 */ 4171 struct mgmt_frame_regs { 4172 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes; 4173 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes; 4174 }; 4175 4176 /** 4177 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration 4178 * 4179 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks 4180 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces. 4181 * 4182 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0 4183 * on success or a negative error code. 4184 * 4185 * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be 4186 * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied 4187 * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering, 4188 * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers. 4189 * 4190 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will 4191 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are 4192 * configured for the device. 4193 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed 4194 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback 4195 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from 4196 * the device. 4197 * 4198 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name, 4199 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create 4200 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct 4201 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must 4202 * also set the address member in the wdev. 4203 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 4204 * 4205 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface 4206 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 4207 * 4208 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface, 4209 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated. 4210 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 4211 * 4212 * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that 4213 * the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link 4214 * address is available. 4215 * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface. 4216 * 4217 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL 4218 * when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. 4219 * For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for 4220 * pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. 4221 * 4222 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters. 4223 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group 4224 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid 4225 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is 4226 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist. 4227 * @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, 4228 * @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr 4229 * will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. 4230 * 4231 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key) 4232 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will 4233 * be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 4234 * for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD 4235 * address for MLO pairwise key. 4236 * 4237 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0 4238 * for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. 4239 * 4240 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface. 4241 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. 4242 * 4243 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface. 4244 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. 4245 * 4246 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver 4247 * 4248 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters. 4249 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode 4250 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started. 4251 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing. 4252 * 4253 * @add_station: Add a new station. 4254 * @del_station: Remove a station 4255 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much 4256 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags 4257 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check 4258 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call 4259 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information. 4260 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac 4261 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx 4262 * 4263 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path 4264 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path 4265 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path 4266 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters 4267 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 4268 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters 4269 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 4270 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters 4271 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4272 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network 4273 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4274 * 4275 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration 4276 * 4277 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh. 4278 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to 4279 * set, and which to leave alone. 4280 * 4281 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS. 4282 * 4283 * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data 4284 * for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called 4285 * from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock. 4286 * The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside 4287 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss. 4288 * The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed. 4289 * 4290 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters 4291 * 4292 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas, 4293 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to 4294 * join the mesh instead. 4295 * 4296 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other 4297 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration. 4298 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should 4299 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active. 4300 * 4301 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given 4302 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done(). 4303 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside 4304 * the scan/scan_done bracket too. 4305 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall 4306 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done(). 4307 * 4308 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer 4309 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4310 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer 4311 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4312 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer 4313 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4314 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer 4315 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4316 * 4317 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected, 4318 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code 4319 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call 4320 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code 4321 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code 4322 * was received. 4323 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the 4324 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated 4325 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches 4326 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request 4327 * frame instead of Association Request frame. 4328 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a 4329 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid 4330 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an 4331 * indication of requesting reassociation. 4332 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming 4333 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to 4334 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4335 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a 4336 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for 4337 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the 4338 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not 4339 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current 4340 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in 4341 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed. 4342 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4343 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if 4344 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in 4345 * case connection was already established (invoked with the 4346 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout(). 4347 * 4348 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call 4349 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due 4350 * to a merge. 4351 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4352 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS. 4353 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4354 * 4355 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or 4356 * MESH mode) 4357 * 4358 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed; 4359 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values 4360 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in 4361 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed. 4362 * 4363 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters, 4364 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The 4365 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will 4366 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power 4367 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.) 4368 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable; 4369 * return 0 if successful 4370 * 4371 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting 4372 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state 4373 * 4374 * @dump_survey: get site survey information. 4375 * 4376 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified 4377 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel 4378 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is 4379 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event 4380 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel(). 4381 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation. 4382 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on 4383 * the duration value. 4384 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame. 4385 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management 4386 * frame on another channel 4387 * 4388 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL 4389 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be 4390 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally, 4391 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the 4392 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data 4393 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present 4394 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA. 4395 * 4396 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration 4397 * 4398 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac 4399 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association 4400 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs. 4401 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID. 4402 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs. 4403 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1 4404 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value. 4405 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold. 4406 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating 4407 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may 4408 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being 4409 * disabled.) 4410 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the 4411 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the 4412 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should 4413 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented. 4414 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config. 4415 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error 4416 * thresholds. 4417 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan. 4418 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with 4419 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready 4420 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be 4421 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case. 4422 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested 4423 * stop (when this method returns 0). 4424 * 4425 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame 4426 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep. 4427 * 4428 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 4429 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 4430 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 4431 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 4432 * 4433 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 4434 * 4435 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame. 4436 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup). 4437 * 4438 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it 4439 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status(). 4440 * 4441 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs. 4442 * 4443 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface. 4444 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single 4445 * current monitoring channel. 4446 * 4447 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device. 4448 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device. 4449 * 4450 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode. 4451 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations 4452 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver 4453 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL 4454 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which 4455 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback. 4456 * 4457 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver. 4458 * 4459 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC 4460 * was finished on another phy. 4461 * 4462 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the 4463 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be 4464 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames. 4465 * 4466 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability 4467 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the 4468 * driver can take the most appropriate actions. 4469 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link 4470 * reliability. This operation can not fail. 4471 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters. 4472 * 4473 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is 4474 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is 4475 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later 4476 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept 4477 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them 4478 * as soon as possible. 4479 * 4480 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver 4481 * 4482 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the 4483 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width 4484 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS. 4485 * 4486 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device 4487 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by 4488 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into 4489 * account. 4490 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure 4491 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return 4492 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake 4493 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later 4494 * rejected) 4495 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS 4496 * 4497 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters 4498 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4499 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network 4500 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4501 * 4502 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 4503 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 4504 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. 4505 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 4506 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 4507 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface. 4508 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface. 4509 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure. 4510 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and 4511 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver 4512 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling 4513 * cfg80211_free_nan_func(). 4514 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the 4515 * provided @nan_func. 4516 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function. 4517 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must 4518 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes); 4519 * All other parameters must be ignored. 4520 * 4521 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS 4522 * 4523 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this 4524 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise. 4525 * 4526 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake. 4527 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect 4528 * upon which the driver should clear it. 4529 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4530 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator. 4531 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4532 * 4533 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from 4534 * user space 4535 * 4536 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter 4537 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted. 4538 * 4539 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 4540 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 4541 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) 4542 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement 4543 * 4544 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME 4545 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated 4546 * DH IE through this interface. 4547 * 4548 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame 4549 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm. 4550 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific 4551 * This callback may sleep. 4552 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the 4553 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep. 4554 * 4555 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. 4556 * 4557 * @color_change: Initiate a color change. 4558 * 4559 * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use 4560 * those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association 4561 * Response frame. 4562 * 4563 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for 4564 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit 4565 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. 4566 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime 4567 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected 4568 * radar channel. 4569 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to 4570 * disable background CAC/radar detection. 4571 * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station. 4572 * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station. 4573 * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station. 4574 * 4575 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. 4576 * @set_ttlm: set the TID to link mapping. 4577 */ 4578 struct cfg80211_ops { 4579 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow); 4580 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4581 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled); 4582 4583 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4584 const char *name, 4585 unsigned char name_assign_type, 4586 enum nl80211_iftype type, 4587 struct vif_params *params); 4588 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4589 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4590 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4591 struct net_device *dev, 4592 enum nl80211_iftype type, 4593 struct vif_params *params); 4594 4595 int (*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4596 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4597 unsigned int link_id); 4598 void (*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4599 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4600 unsigned int link_id); 4601 4602 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4603 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, 4604 const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params); 4605 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4606 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, 4607 const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie, 4608 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*)); 4609 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4610 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, 4611 const u8 *mac_addr); 4612 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4613 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id, 4614 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast); 4615 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4616 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id, 4617 u8 key_index); 4618 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4619 struct net_device *netdev, 4620 int link_id, 4621 u8 key_index); 4622 4623 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4624 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings); 4625 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4626 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info); 4627 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4628 unsigned int link_id); 4629 4630 4631 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4632 const u8 *mac, 4633 struct station_parameters *params); 4634 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4635 struct station_del_parameters *params); 4636 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4637 const u8 *mac, 4638 struct station_parameters *params); 4639 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4640 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 4641 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4642 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 4643 4644 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4645 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 4646 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4647 const u8 *dst); 4648 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4649 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 4650 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4651 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4652 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4653 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, 4654 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4655 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4656 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4657 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4658 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, 4659 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4660 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4661 struct net_device *dev, 4662 struct mesh_config *conf); 4663 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4664 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask, 4665 const struct mesh_config *nconf); 4666 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4667 const struct mesh_config *conf, 4668 const struct mesh_setup *setup); 4669 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4670 4671 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4672 struct ocb_setup *setup); 4673 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4674 4675 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4676 struct bss_parameters *params); 4677 4678 void (*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 4679 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data); 4680 4681 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4682 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params); 4683 4684 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4685 struct net_device *dev, 4686 struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 4687 4688 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4689 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4690 4691 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4692 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request); 4693 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4694 4695 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4696 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req); 4697 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4698 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req); 4699 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4700 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req); 4701 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4702 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req); 4703 4704 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4705 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme); 4706 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4707 struct net_device *dev, 4708 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme, 4709 u32 changed); 4710 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4711 u16 reason_code); 4712 4713 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4714 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params); 4715 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4716 4717 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4718 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]); 4719 4720 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed); 4721 4722 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4723 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm); 4724 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4725 int *dbm); 4726 4727 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4728 4729 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4730 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4731 void *data, int len); 4732 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb, 4733 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4734 void *data, int len); 4735 #endif 4736 4737 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4738 struct net_device *dev, 4739 unsigned int link_id, 4740 const u8 *peer, 4741 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4742 4743 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4744 int idx, struct survey_info *info); 4745 4746 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4747 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4748 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4749 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4750 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev); 4751 4752 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4753 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4754 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4755 unsigned int duration, 4756 u64 *cookie); 4757 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4758 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4759 u64 cookie); 4760 4761 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4762 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params, 4763 u64 *cookie); 4764 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4765 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4766 u64 cookie); 4767 4768 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4769 bool enabled, int timeout); 4770 4771 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4772 struct net_device *dev, 4773 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst); 4774 4775 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4776 struct net_device *dev, 4777 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high); 4778 4779 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4780 struct net_device *dev, 4781 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl); 4782 4783 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4784 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4785 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd); 4786 4787 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4788 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4789 4790 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4791 struct net_device *dev, 4792 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request); 4793 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4794 u64 reqid); 4795 4796 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4797 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4798 4799 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4800 const u8 *peer, int link_id, 4801 u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code, 4802 u32 peer_capability, bool initiator, 4803 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4804 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4805 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper); 4806 4807 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4808 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie); 4809 4810 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4811 struct net_device *dev, 4812 u16 noack_map); 4813 4814 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4815 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4816 unsigned int link_id, 4817 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4818 4819 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4820 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4821 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4822 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4823 4824 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4825 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params); 4826 4827 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4828 struct net_device *dev, 4829 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4830 u32 cac_time_ms); 4831 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4832 struct net_device *dev); 4833 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4834 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie); 4835 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4836 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4837 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol, 4838 u16 duration); 4839 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4840 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4841 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4842 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce); 4843 4844 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4845 struct net_device *dev, 4846 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params); 4847 4848 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4849 struct net_device *dev, 4850 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 4851 4852 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4853 unsigned int link_id, 4854 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4855 4856 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4857 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio, 4858 u16 admitted_time); 4859 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4860 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer); 4861 4862 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4863 struct net_device *dev, 4864 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class, 4865 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4866 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4867 struct net_device *dev, 4868 const u8 *addr); 4869 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4870 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4871 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4872 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4873 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4874 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4875 u64 cookie); 4876 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4877 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4878 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, 4879 u32 changes); 4880 4881 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4882 struct net_device *dev, 4883 const bool enabled); 4884 4885 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4886 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4887 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats); 4888 4889 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4890 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf); 4891 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4892 const u8 *aa); 4893 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4894 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params); 4895 4896 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4897 struct net_device *dev, 4898 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 4899 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto, 4900 const bool noencrypt, int link_id, 4901 u64 *cookie); 4902 4903 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4904 struct net_device *dev, 4905 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4906 4907 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4908 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4909 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4910 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4911 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4912 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info); 4913 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4914 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4915 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4916 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4917 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4918 const u8 *peer, u8 tids); 4919 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4920 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); 4921 int (*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4922 struct net_device *dev, 4923 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params); 4924 int (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4925 struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad); 4926 int (*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4927 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4928 int (*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4929 struct link_station_parameters *params); 4930 int (*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4931 struct link_station_parameters *params); 4932 int (*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4933 struct link_station_del_parameters *params); 4934 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4935 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts); 4936 int (*set_ttlm)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4937 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params *params); 4938 }; 4939 4940 /* 4941 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures 4942 * and registration/helper functions 4943 */ 4944 4945 /** 4946 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags 4947 * 4948 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split 4949 * into two, first for legacy bands and second for 6 GHz. 4950 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this 4951 * wiphy at all 4952 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled 4953 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default 4954 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good 4955 * reason to override the default 4956 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station 4957 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of 4958 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype. 4959 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station 4960 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the 4961 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the 4962 * control_port_no_encrypt flag. 4963 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN. 4964 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing 4965 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH. 4966 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the 4967 * firmware. 4968 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP. 4969 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation. 4970 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z) 4971 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and 4972 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT 4973 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 4974 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation. 4975 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME 4976 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes 4977 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling 4978 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(). 4979 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device 4980 * responds to probe-requests in hardware. 4981 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX. 4982 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call. 4983 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels. 4984 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in 4985 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...). 4986 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys 4987 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs, 4988 * in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have 4989 * complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver 4990 * should set this flag for now. 4991 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys. 4992 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for 4993 * NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER. 4994 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver 4995 * set this flag to update channels on beacon hints. 4996 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: support connection to non-primary link 4997 * of an NSTR mobile AP MLD. 4998 * @WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT: disable wireless extensions for this device 4999 */ 5000 enum wiphy_flags { 5001 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0), 5002 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO = BIT(1), 5003 WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2), 5004 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3), 5005 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4), 5006 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5), 5007 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6), 5008 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7), 5009 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8), 5010 WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT = BIT(9), 5011 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10), 5012 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32 = BIT(11), 5013 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY = BIT(12), 5014 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13), 5015 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14), 5016 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15), 5017 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16), 5018 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17), 5019 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18), 5020 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19), 5021 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20), 5022 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21), 5023 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22), 5024 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23), 5025 WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER = BIT(24), 5026 WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON = BIT(25), 5027 }; 5028 5029 /** 5030 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types 5031 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types 5032 * @types: interface types (bits) 5033 */ 5034 struct ieee80211_iface_limit { 5035 u16 max; 5036 u16 types; 5037 }; 5038 5039 /** 5040 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination 5041 * 5042 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface 5043 * combinations it supports concurrently. 5044 * 5045 * Examples: 5046 * 5047 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total: 5048 * 5049 * .. code-block:: c 5050 * 5051 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = { 5052 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 5053 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), }, 5054 * }; 5055 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = { 5056 * .limits = limits1, 5057 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1), 5058 * .max_interfaces = 2, 5059 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true, 5060 * }; 5061 * 5062 * 5063 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total: 5064 * 5065 * .. code-block:: c 5066 * 5067 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = { 5068 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) | 5069 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), }, 5070 * }; 5071 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = { 5072 * .limits = limits2, 5073 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2), 5074 * .max_interfaces = 8, 5075 * .num_different_channels = 1, 5076 * }; 5077 * 5078 * 5079 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total. 5080 * 5081 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections. 5082 * 5083 * .. code-block:: c 5084 * 5085 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = { 5086 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 5087 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) | 5088 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), }, 5089 * }; 5090 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = { 5091 * .limits = limits3, 5092 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3), 5093 * .max_interfaces = 4, 5094 * .num_different_channels = 2, 5095 * }; 5096 * 5097 */ 5098 struct ieee80211_iface_combination { 5099 /** 5100 * @limits: 5101 * limits for the given interface types 5102 */ 5103 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits; 5104 5105 /** 5106 * @num_different_channels: 5107 * can use up to this many different channels 5108 */ 5109 u32 num_different_channels; 5110 5111 /** 5112 * @max_interfaces: 5113 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group 5114 */ 5115 u16 max_interfaces; 5116 5117 /** 5118 * @n_limits: 5119 * number of limitations 5120 */ 5121 u8 n_limits; 5122 5123 /** 5124 * @beacon_int_infra_match: 5125 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure 5126 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases. 5127 */ 5128 bool beacon_int_infra_match; 5129 5130 /** 5131 * @radar_detect_widths: 5132 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection 5133 */ 5134 u8 radar_detect_widths; 5135 5136 /** 5137 * @radar_detect_regions: 5138 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection 5139 */ 5140 u8 radar_detect_regions; 5141 5142 /** 5143 * @beacon_int_min_gcd: 5144 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals. 5145 * 5146 * = 0 5147 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same. 5148 * > 0 5149 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND 5150 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this 5151 * combination must be greater or equal to this value. 5152 */ 5153 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd; 5154 }; 5155 5156 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes { 5157 u16 tx, rx; 5158 }; 5159 5160 /** 5161 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags 5162 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any" 5163 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and 5164 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a 5165 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the 5166 * packet should be preserved in that case 5167 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet 5168 * (see nl80211.h) 5169 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect 5170 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep 5171 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure 5172 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request 5173 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure 5174 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release 5175 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection 5176 */ 5177 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags { 5178 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0), 5179 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1), 5180 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2), 5181 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3), 5182 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4), 5183 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5), 5184 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6), 5185 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7), 5186 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8), 5187 }; 5188 5189 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support { 5190 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok; 5191 u32 data_payload_max; 5192 u32 data_interval_max; 5193 u32 wake_payload_max; 5194 bool seq; 5195 }; 5196 5197 /** 5198 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data 5199 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags 5200 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns 5201 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 5202 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 5203 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 5204 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 5205 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect, 5206 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for 5207 * scheduled scans. 5208 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more 5209 * details. 5210 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information 5211 */ 5212 struct wiphy_wowlan_support { 5213 u32 flags; 5214 int n_patterns; 5215 int pattern_max_len; 5216 int pattern_min_len; 5217 int max_pkt_offset; 5218 int max_nd_match_sets; 5219 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp; 5220 }; 5221 5222 /** 5223 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data 5224 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules 5225 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 5226 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule 5227 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 5228 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 5229 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 5230 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 5231 */ 5232 struct wiphy_coalesce_support { 5233 int n_rules; 5234 int max_delay; 5235 int n_patterns; 5236 int pattern_max_len; 5237 int pattern_min_len; 5238 int max_pkt_offset; 5239 }; 5240 5241 /** 5242 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands 5243 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev 5244 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev 5245 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running 5246 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV) 5247 */ 5248 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags { 5249 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0), 5250 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1), 5251 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2), 5252 }; 5253 5254 /** 5255 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags 5256 * 5257 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed 5258 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed 5259 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed 5260 * 5261 */ 5262 enum wiphy_opmode_flag { 5263 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 5264 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1), 5265 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2), 5266 }; 5267 5268 /** 5269 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information 5270 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag 5271 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station 5272 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station 5273 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station 5274 */ 5275 5276 struct sta_opmode_info { 5277 u32 changed; 5278 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 5279 enum nl80211_chan_width bw; 5280 u8 rx_nss; 5281 }; 5282 5283 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA)) 5284 5285 /** 5286 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition 5287 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211 5288 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags 5289 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the 5290 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data 5291 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all 5292 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The 5293 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple 5294 * dumpit calls. 5295 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 5296 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the 5297 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command). 5298 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy 5299 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and 5300 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others 5301 * are used with dump requests. 5302 */ 5303 struct wiphy_vendor_command { 5304 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info; 5305 u32 flags; 5306 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 5307 const void *data, int data_len); 5308 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 5309 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len, 5310 unsigned long *storage); 5311 const struct nla_policy *policy; 5312 unsigned int maxattr; 5313 }; 5314 5315 /** 5316 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type 5317 * @iftype: interface type 5318 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 5319 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the 5320 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are 5321 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std 5322 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. 5323 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 5324 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 5325 * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO) 5326 * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO) 5327 */ 5328 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab { 5329 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 5330 const u8 *extended_capabilities; 5331 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask; 5332 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 5333 u16 eml_capabilities; 5334 u16 mld_capa_and_ops; 5335 }; 5336 5337 /** 5338 * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability 5339 * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from 5340 * @type: the interface type to look up 5341 * 5342 * Return: The extended capability for the given interface @type, may be %NULL 5343 */ 5344 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab * 5345 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type); 5346 5347 /** 5348 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities 5349 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement 5350 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement 5351 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement 5352 * @ftm: FTM measurement data 5353 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported 5354 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported 5355 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported 5356 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data 5357 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data 5358 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble) 5359 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width) 5360 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported 5361 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily 5362 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick) 5363 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if 5364 * not limited) 5365 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported 5366 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported 5367 */ 5368 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities { 5369 unsigned int max_peers; 5370 u8 report_ap_tsf:1, 5371 randomize_mac_addr:1; 5372 5373 struct { 5374 u32 preambles; 5375 u32 bandwidths; 5376 s8 max_bursts_exponent; 5377 u8 max_ftms_per_burst; 5378 u8 supported:1, 5379 asap:1, 5380 non_asap:1, 5381 request_lci:1, 5382 request_civicloc:1, 5383 trigger_based:1, 5384 non_trigger_based:1; 5385 } ftm; 5386 }; 5387 5388 /** 5389 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm 5390 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the 5391 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites. 5392 * 5393 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types 5394 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites 5395 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 5396 */ 5397 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites { 5398 u16 iftypes_mask; 5399 const u32 *akm_suites; 5400 int n_akm_suites; 5401 }; 5402 5403 #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS 0xffff 5404 5405 /** 5406 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description 5407 * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device 5408 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback, 5409 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory() 5410 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL 5411 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via 5412 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver 5413 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future 5414 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers. 5415 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss. 5416 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites 5417 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites 5418 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if 5419 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in 5420 * iftype_akm_suites. 5421 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 5422 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type. 5423 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot 5424 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all 5425 * instances of iftype_akm_suites). 5426 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm 5427 * suites are specified separately. 5428 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit) 5429 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit) 5430 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold); 5431 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used 5432 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled 5433 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in 5434 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device 5435 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking, 5436 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last 5437 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual 5438 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with 5439 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up. 5440 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses. 5441 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer 5442 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used 5443 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to 5444 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle 5445 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses. 5446 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against 5447 * unregister hardware 5448 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>). 5449 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames 5450 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in 5451 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev() 5452 * (see below). 5453 * @wext: wireless extension handlers 5454 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter) 5455 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy, 5456 * must be set by driver 5457 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not 5458 * list single interface types. 5459 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array. 5460 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not 5461 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW. 5462 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags 5463 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see 5464 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags 5465 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags. 5466 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see 5467 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index. 5468 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it, 5469 * this variable determines its size 5470 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in 5471 * any given scan 5472 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that 5473 * the device can run concurrently. 5474 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan 5475 * for in any given scheduled scan 5476 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle 5477 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not 5478 * supported. 5479 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can 5480 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not 5481 * include fixed IEs like supported rates 5482 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled 5483 * scans 5484 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number 5485 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device. 5486 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a 5487 * single scan plan supported by the device. 5488 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single 5489 * scan plan supported by the device. 5490 * @coverage_class: current coverage class 5491 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting 5492 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting 5493 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device 5494 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary 5495 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers 5496 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device 5497 * 5498 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or 5499 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface 5500 * type 5501 * 5502 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 5503 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 5504 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set. 5505 * 5506 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 5507 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 5508 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set. 5509 * 5510 * @probe_resp_offload: 5511 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading. 5512 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid 5513 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set. 5514 * 5515 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation 5516 * may request, if implemented. 5517 * 5518 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information 5519 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be 5520 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed 5521 * to the suspend() operation instead. 5522 * 5523 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 5524 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden. 5525 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 5526 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden. 5527 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 5528 * 5529 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must 5530 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection. 5531 * 5532 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device 5533 * supports for ACL. 5534 * 5535 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 5536 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are 5537 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") 5538 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See 5539 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default 5540 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified 5541 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab. 5542 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 5543 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 5544 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type 5545 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended 5546 * capabilities are specified separately. 5547 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information 5548 * 5549 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware 5550 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands 5551 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware 5552 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events 5553 * 5554 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode 5555 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The 5556 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in 5557 * some cases, but may not always reach. 5558 * 5559 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons 5560 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver 5561 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means 5562 * infinite. 5563 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported 5564 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the 5565 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr. 5566 * 5567 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a 5568 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for 5569 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 5570 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 5571 * 5572 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit 5573 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit 5574 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum 5575 * 5576 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using 5577 * wake_tx_queue 5578 * 5579 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP 5580 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not 5581 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues. 5582 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect. 5583 * 5584 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities 5585 * 5586 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the 5587 * device has 5588 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 5589 * supported by the driver for each vif 5590 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 5591 * supported by the driver for each peer 5592 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for 5593 * long/short retry configuration 5594 * 5595 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for 5596 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and 5597 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes 5598 * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities 5599 * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure 5600 * 5601 * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver 5602 * in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value 5603 * by the driver to advertise MBSSID support. 5604 * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by 5605 * the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the 5606 * driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP). 5607 * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for 5608 * configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and 5609 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by 5610 * driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is 5611 * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with 5612 * legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is 5613 * CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES. 5614 * 5615 * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports 5616 * enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a 5617 * non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping. 5618 * A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver 5619 * supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to 5620 * specify a mac address). 5621 */ 5622 struct wiphy { 5623 struct mutex mtx; 5624 5625 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */ 5626 5627 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN]; 5628 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN]; 5629 5630 struct mac_address *addresses; 5631 5632 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes; 5633 5634 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations; 5635 int n_iface_combinations; 5636 u16 software_iftypes; 5637 5638 u16 n_addresses; 5639 5640 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */ 5641 u16 interface_modes; 5642 5643 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs; 5644 5645 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features; 5646 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)]; 5647 5648 u32 ap_sme_capa; 5649 5650 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type; 5651 5652 int bss_priv_size; 5653 u8 max_scan_ssids; 5654 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs; 5655 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids; 5656 u8 max_match_sets; 5657 u16 max_scan_ie_len; 5658 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len; 5659 u32 max_sched_scan_plans; 5660 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval; 5661 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations; 5662 5663 int n_cipher_suites; 5664 const u32 *cipher_suites; 5665 5666 int n_akm_suites; 5667 const u32 *akm_suites; 5668 5669 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites; 5670 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites; 5671 5672 u8 retry_short; 5673 u8 retry_long; 5674 u32 frag_threshold; 5675 u32 rts_threshold; 5676 u8 coverage_class; 5677 5678 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN]; 5679 u32 hw_version; 5680 5681 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 5682 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan; 5683 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config; 5684 #endif 5685 5686 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration; 5687 5688 u8 max_num_pmkids; 5689 5690 u32 available_antennas_tx; 5691 u32 available_antennas_rx; 5692 5693 u32 probe_resp_offload; 5694 5695 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask; 5696 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 5697 5698 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab; 5699 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab; 5700 5701 const void *privid; 5702 5703 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 5704 5705 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5706 struct regulatory_request *request); 5707 5708 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */ 5709 5710 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd; 5711 5712 struct device dev; 5713 5714 bool registered; 5715 5716 struct dentry *debugfsdir; 5717 5718 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask; 5719 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask; 5720 5721 struct list_head wdev_list; 5722 5723 possible_net_t _net; 5724 5725 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 5726 const struct iw_handler_def *wext; 5727 #endif 5728 5729 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce; 5730 5731 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands; 5732 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events; 5733 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events; 5734 5735 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta; 5736 5737 u8 max_num_csa_counters; 5738 5739 u32 bss_select_support; 5740 5741 u8 nan_supported_bands; 5742 5743 u32 txq_limit; 5744 u32 txq_memory_limit; 5745 u32 txq_quantum; 5746 5747 unsigned long tx_queue_len; 5748 5749 u8 support_mbssid:1, 5750 support_only_he_mbssid:1; 5751 5752 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa; 5753 5754 struct { 5755 u64 peer, vif; 5756 u8 max_retry; 5757 } tid_config_support; 5758 5759 u8 max_data_retry_count; 5760 5761 const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa; 5762 5763 struct rfkill *rfkill; 5764 5765 u8 mbssid_max_interfaces; 5766 u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity; 5767 u16 max_num_akm_suites; 5768 5769 u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers; 5770 5771 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN); 5772 }; 5773 5774 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5775 { 5776 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net); 5777 } 5778 5779 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net) 5780 { 5781 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net); 5782 } 5783 5784 /** 5785 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy 5786 * 5787 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return 5788 * Return: The priv of @wiphy. 5789 */ 5790 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5791 { 5792 BUG_ON(!wiphy); 5793 return &wiphy->priv; 5794 } 5795 5796 /** 5797 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv 5798 * 5799 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv 5800 * Return: The wiphy of @priv. 5801 */ 5802 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv) 5803 { 5804 BUG_ON(!priv); 5805 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv); 5806 } 5807 5808 /** 5809 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy 5810 * 5811 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind 5812 * @dev: The device to parent it to 5813 */ 5814 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev) 5815 { 5816 wiphy->dev.parent = dev; 5817 } 5818 5819 /** 5820 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer 5821 * 5822 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up 5823 * Return: The dev of @wiphy. 5824 */ 5825 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5826 { 5827 return wiphy->dev.parent; 5828 } 5829 5830 /** 5831 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name 5832 * 5833 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return 5834 * Return: The name of @wiphy. 5835 */ 5836 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy) 5837 { 5838 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev); 5839 } 5840 5841 /** 5842 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5843 * 5844 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5845 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5846 * @requested_name: Request a particular name. 5847 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming. 5848 * 5849 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5850 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5851 * 5852 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5853 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5854 */ 5855 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv, 5856 const char *requested_name); 5857 5858 /** 5859 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5860 * 5861 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5862 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5863 * 5864 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5865 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5866 * 5867 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5868 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5869 */ 5870 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, 5871 int sizeof_priv) 5872 { 5873 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL); 5874 } 5875 5876 /** 5877 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211 5878 * 5879 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register. 5880 * 5881 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code. 5882 */ 5883 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5884 5885 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */ 5886 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx) 5887 5888 /** 5889 * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking 5890 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on 5891 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing 5892 * 5893 * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock() 5894 * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference(). 5895 */ 5896 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p) \ 5897 rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) 5898 5899 /** 5900 * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx 5901 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on 5902 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing 5903 * 5904 * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the 5905 * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates. 5906 */ 5907 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p) \ 5908 rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) 5909 5910 /** 5911 * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy 5912 * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from 5913 * 5914 * Context: Requires any of RTNL, wiphy mutex or RCU protection. 5915 * 5916 * Return: pointer to the regulatory domain associated with the wiphy 5917 */ 5918 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5919 5920 /** 5921 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211 5922 * 5923 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister. 5924 * 5925 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv 5926 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding 5927 * request that is being handled. 5928 */ 5929 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5930 5931 /** 5932 * wiphy_free - free wiphy 5933 * 5934 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free 5935 */ 5936 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5937 5938 /* internal structs */ 5939 struct cfg80211_conn; 5940 struct cfg80211_internal_bss; 5941 struct cfg80211_cached_keys; 5942 struct cfg80211_cqm_config; 5943 5944 /** 5945 * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy 5946 * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock 5947 * 5948 * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that 5949 * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking 5950 * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot 5951 * differentiate which way it's called. 5952 * 5953 * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes. 5954 * 5955 * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked. 5956 * 5957 * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued 5958 * with wiphy_queue_work() are running. 5959 */ 5960 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5961 __acquires(&wiphy->mtx) 5962 { 5963 mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx); 5964 __acquire(&wiphy->mtx); 5965 } 5966 5967 /** 5968 * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again 5969 * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock 5970 */ 5971 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5972 __releases(&wiphy->mtx) 5973 { 5974 __release(&wiphy->mtx); 5975 mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx); 5976 } 5977 5978 struct wiphy_work; 5979 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *); 5980 5981 struct wiphy_work { 5982 struct list_head entry; 5983 wiphy_work_func_t func; 5984 }; 5985 5986 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work, 5987 wiphy_work_func_t func) 5988 { 5989 INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry); 5990 work->func = func; 5991 } 5992 5993 /** 5994 * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy 5995 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for 5996 * @work: the work item 5997 * 5998 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work 5999 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be 6000 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running 6001 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can 6002 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires 6003 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock(). 6004 */ 6005 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); 6006 6007 /** 6008 * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work 6009 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes 6010 * @work: the work to cancel 6011 * 6012 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being 6013 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). 6014 */ 6015 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); 6016 6017 /** 6018 * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work 6019 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes 6020 * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work 6021 * 6022 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called 6023 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). 6024 */ 6025 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); 6026 6027 struct wiphy_delayed_work { 6028 struct wiphy_work work; 6029 struct wiphy *wiphy; 6030 struct timer_list timer; 6031 }; 6032 6033 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t); 6034 6035 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork, 6036 wiphy_work_func_t func) 6037 { 6038 timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0); 6039 wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func); 6040 } 6041 6042 /** 6043 * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy 6044 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for 6045 * @dwork: the delayable worker 6046 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing 6047 * 6048 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work 6049 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be 6050 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running 6051 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can 6052 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires 6053 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock(). 6054 */ 6055 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6056 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork, 6057 unsigned long delay); 6058 6059 /** 6060 * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work 6061 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes 6062 * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel 6063 * 6064 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being 6065 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). 6066 */ 6067 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6068 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork); 6069 6070 /** 6071 * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work 6072 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes 6073 * @dwork: the delayed work to flush 6074 * 6075 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called 6076 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). 6077 */ 6078 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6079 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork); 6080 6081 /** 6082 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state 6083 * 6084 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver 6085 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this 6086 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.) 6087 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will 6088 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device, 6089 * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or 6090 * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops 6091 * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.) 6092 * 6093 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver 6094 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as 6095 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be 6096 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it. 6097 * 6098 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description 6099 * @iftype: interface type 6100 * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211 6101 * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock 6102 * for the notifier 6103 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces 6104 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL 6105 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this 6106 * wireless device if it has no netdev 6107 * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype 6108 * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode) 6109 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code 6110 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling 6111 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data 6112 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data 6113 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association 6114 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements 6115 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID 6116 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID 6117 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index 6118 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index 6119 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation 6120 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity 6121 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be 6122 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the 6123 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update 6124 * by cfg80211 on change_interface 6125 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames 6126 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated, 6127 * need to propagate the update to the driver 6128 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL 6129 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g. 6130 * the P2P Device. 6131 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started 6132 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 6133 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms 6134 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled 6135 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout 6136 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application 6137 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode) 6138 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data 6139 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established 6140 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type 6141 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID 6142 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work 6143 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect 6144 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing 6145 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list 6146 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID 6147 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away 6148 * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work 6149 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state 6150 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests 6151 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock 6152 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work 6153 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last 6154 * unprotected beacon report 6155 * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr 6156 * @ap and @client for each link 6157 * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid 6158 */ 6159 struct wireless_dev { 6160 struct wiphy *wiphy; 6161 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 6162 6163 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */ 6164 struct list_head list; 6165 struct net_device *netdev; 6166 6167 u32 identifier; 6168 6169 struct list_head mgmt_registrations; 6170 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1; 6171 6172 bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering; 6173 6174 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16)); 6175 6176 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */ 6177 struct cfg80211_conn *conn; 6178 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys; 6179 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type; 6180 u32 conn_owner_nlportid; 6181 6182 struct work_struct disconnect_wk; 6183 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 6184 6185 struct list_head event_list; 6186 spinlock_t event_lock; 6187 6188 u8 connected:1; 6189 6190 bool ps; 6191 int ps_timeout; 6192 6193 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid; 6194 6195 u32 owner_nlportid; 6196 bool nl_owner_dead; 6197 6198 /* FIXME: need to rework radar detection for MLO */ 6199 bool cac_started; 6200 unsigned long cac_start_time; 6201 unsigned int cac_time_ms; 6202 6203 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 6204 /* wext data */ 6205 struct { 6206 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss; 6207 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect; 6208 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys; 6209 const u8 *ie; 6210 size_t ie_len; 6211 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 6212 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 6213 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6214 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key; 6215 bool prev_bssid_valid; 6216 } wext; 6217 #endif 6218 6219 struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work; 6220 struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config; 6221 6222 struct list_head pmsr_list; 6223 spinlock_t pmsr_lock; 6224 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk; 6225 6226 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported; 6227 6228 union { 6229 struct { 6230 u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 6231 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6232 u8 ssid_len; 6233 } client; 6234 struct { 6235 int beacon_interval; 6236 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; 6237 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 6238 u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_MESH_ID_LEN]; 6239 u8 id_len, id_up_len; 6240 } mesh; 6241 struct { 6242 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; 6243 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6244 u8 ssid_len; 6245 } ap; 6246 struct { 6247 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; 6248 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 6249 int beacon_interval; 6250 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6251 u8 ssid_len; 6252 } ibss; 6253 struct { 6254 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 6255 } ocb; 6256 } u; 6257 6258 struct { 6259 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 6260 union { 6261 struct { 6262 unsigned int beacon_interval; 6263 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 6264 } ap; 6265 struct { 6266 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; 6267 } client; 6268 }; 6269 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 6270 u16 valid_links; 6271 }; 6272 6273 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 6274 { 6275 if (wdev->netdev) 6276 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr; 6277 return wdev->address; 6278 } 6279 6280 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 6281 { 6282 if (wdev->netdev) 6283 return netif_running(wdev->netdev); 6284 return wdev->is_running; 6285 } 6286 6287 /** 6288 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev 6289 * 6290 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return 6291 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev. 6292 */ 6293 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 6294 { 6295 BUG_ON(!wdev); 6296 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy); 6297 } 6298 6299 /** 6300 * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev 6301 * @wdev: the wdev 6302 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO 6303 * 6304 * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL. 6305 */ 6306 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6307 unsigned int link_id); 6308 6309 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6310 unsigned int link_id) 6311 { 6312 WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links); 6313 WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links && 6314 !(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id))); 6315 } 6316 6317 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id) \ 6318 for (link_id = 0; \ 6319 link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ? \ 6320 ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1); \ 6321 link_id++) \ 6322 if (!(link_info)->valid_links || \ 6323 ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id))) 6324 6325 /** 6326 * DOC: Utility functions 6327 * 6328 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful. 6329 */ 6330 6331 /** 6332 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel 6333 * 6334 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel 6335 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel 6336 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b 6337 */ 6338 static inline bool 6339 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a, 6340 struct ieee80211_channel *b) 6341 { 6342 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq && 6343 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset); 6344 } 6345 6346 /** 6347 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz 6348 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert 6349 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz) 6350 */ 6351 static inline u32 6352 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 6353 { 6354 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset; 6355 } 6356 6357 /** 6358 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan 6359 * 6360 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ 6361 * @chan: channel 6362 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq 6363 */ 6364 enum nl80211_chan_width 6365 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 6366 6367 /** 6368 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency 6369 * @chan: channel number 6370 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 6371 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 6372 */ 6373 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band); 6374 6375 /** 6376 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency 6377 * @chan: channel number 6378 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 6379 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 6380 */ 6381 static inline int 6382 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band) 6383 { 6384 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band)); 6385 } 6386 6387 /** 6388 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 6389 * @freq: center frequency in KHz 6390 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 6391 */ 6392 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq); 6393 6394 /** 6395 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 6396 * @freq: center frequency in MHz 6397 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 6398 */ 6399 static inline int 6400 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq) 6401 { 6402 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 6403 } 6404 6405 /** 6406 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified 6407 * frequency 6408 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 6409 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel 6410 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 6411 */ 6412 struct ieee80211_channel * 6413 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq); 6414 6415 /** 6416 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency 6417 * 6418 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 6419 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel 6420 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 6421 */ 6422 static inline struct ieee80211_channel * 6423 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq) 6424 { 6425 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 6426 } 6427 6428 /** 6429 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC 6430 * @chan: control channel to check 6431 * 6432 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in 6433 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3 6434 * 6435 * Return: %true if channel is a PSC, %false otherwise 6436 */ 6437 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 6438 { 6439 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ) 6440 return false; 6441 6442 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5; 6443 } 6444 6445 /** 6446 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate 6447 * 6448 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 6449 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates 6450 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate 6451 * 6452 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that 6453 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map, 6454 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of 6455 * rates in the band's bitrate table. 6456 */ 6457 const struct ieee80211_rate * 6458 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6459 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate); 6460 6461 /** 6462 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band 6463 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 6464 * 6465 * Return: a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given band, bits 6466 * are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array. 6467 */ 6468 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband); 6469 6470 /* 6471 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support 6472 * 6473 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c 6474 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst 6475 */ 6476 6477 struct radiotap_align_size { 6478 uint8_t align:4, size:4; 6479 }; 6480 6481 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace { 6482 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size; 6483 int n_bits; 6484 uint32_t oui; 6485 uint8_t subns; 6486 }; 6487 6488 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces { 6489 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns; 6490 int n_ns; 6491 }; 6492 6493 /** 6494 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args 6495 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call 6496 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() 6497 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each 6498 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after 6499 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to 6500 * the beginning of the actual data portion 6501 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience 6502 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition 6503 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown) 6504 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default 6505 * radiotap namespace or not 6506 * 6507 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through 6508 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering 6509 * @_arg_index: next argument index 6510 * @_arg: next argument pointer 6511 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32 6512 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present 6513 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions 6514 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data 6515 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the 6516 * next bitmap word 6517 * 6518 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore 6519 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally. 6520 */ 6521 6522 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator { 6523 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader; 6524 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns; 6525 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace; 6526 6527 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data; 6528 __le32 *_next_bitmap; 6529 6530 unsigned char *this_arg; 6531 int this_arg_index; 6532 int this_arg_size; 6533 6534 int is_radiotap_ns; 6535 6536 int _max_length; 6537 int _arg_index; 6538 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter; 6539 int _reset_on_ext; 6540 }; 6541 6542 int 6543 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator, 6544 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header, 6545 int max_length, 6546 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns); 6547 6548 int 6549 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator); 6550 6551 6552 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6]; 6553 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6]; 6554 6555 /** 6556 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data 6557 * 6558 * @skb: the frame 6559 * 6560 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function 6561 * returns the 802.11 header length. 6562 * 6563 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption 6564 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid 6565 * 802.11 header. 6566 */ 6567 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb); 6568 6569 /** 6570 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control 6571 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format 6572 * Return: The header length in bytes. 6573 */ 6574 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc); 6575 6576 /** 6577 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length 6578 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field 6579 * (first byte) will be accessed 6580 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at 6581 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present. 6582 */ 6583 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr); 6584 6585 /** 6586 * DOC: Data path helpers 6587 * 6588 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers 6589 * functions that help implement the data path for devices 6590 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device. 6591 */ 6592 6593 /** 6594 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 6595 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 6596 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead 6597 * of it being pushed into the SKB 6598 * @addr: the device MAC address 6599 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 6600 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header 6601 * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU 6602 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 6603 */ 6604 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr, 6605 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 6606 u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu); 6607 6608 /** 6609 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 6610 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 6611 * @addr: the device MAC address 6612 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 6613 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 6614 */ 6615 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr, 6616 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 6617 { 6618 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false); 6619 } 6620 6621 /** 6622 * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid 6623 * 6624 * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated 6625 * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the 6626 * mesh control field. 6627 * 6628 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. 6629 * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test 6630 * 0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field 6631 * 1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field 6632 * 2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field 6633 * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode 6634 */ 6635 bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr); 6636 6637 /** 6638 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame 6639 * 6640 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames. 6641 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully 6642 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function. 6643 * 6644 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. 6645 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and 6646 * initialized by the caller. 6647 * @addr: The device MAC address. 6648 * @iftype: The device interface type. 6649 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list. 6650 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 6651 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 6652 * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu 6653 */ 6654 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list, 6655 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 6656 const unsigned int extra_headroom, 6657 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa, 6658 u8 mesh_control); 6659 6660 /** 6661 * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol 6662 * 6663 * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated 6664 * protocol. 6665 * 6666 * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload 6667 * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol 6668 * Return: true if encapsulation was found 6669 */ 6670 bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto); 6671 6672 /** 6673 * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames 6674 * 6675 * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part 6676 * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh 6677 * header to the ethernet header (if present). 6678 * 6679 * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header 6680 * 6681 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 6682 */ 6683 int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb); 6684 6685 /** 6686 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame 6687 * @skb: the data frame 6688 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use 6689 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag. 6690 */ 6691 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb, 6692 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 6693 6694 /** 6695 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data 6696 * 6697 * @eid: element ID 6698 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6699 * @len: length of data 6700 * @match: byte array to match 6701 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 6702 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match. 6703 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers 6704 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take 6705 * the data portion instead. 6706 * 6707 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 6708 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6709 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 6710 * requested element struct. 6711 * 6712 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6713 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 6714 * byte array to match. 6715 */ 6716 const struct element * 6717 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 6718 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 6719 unsigned int match_offset); 6720 6721 /** 6722 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data 6723 * 6724 * @eid: element ID 6725 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6726 * @len: length of data 6727 * @match: byte array to match 6728 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 6729 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match. 6730 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero. 6731 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first 6732 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and 6733 * the second byte is the IE length. 6734 * 6735 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 6736 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6737 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first 6738 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 6739 * element ID. 6740 * 6741 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6742 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 6743 * byte array to match. 6744 */ 6745 static inline const u8 * 6746 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 6747 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 6748 unsigned int match_offset) 6749 { 6750 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is 6751 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well. 6752 */ 6753 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) || 6754 (!match_len && match_offset))) 6755 return NULL; 6756 6757 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, 6758 match, match_len, 6759 match_offset ? 6760 match_offset - 2 : 0); 6761 } 6762 6763 /** 6764 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data 6765 * 6766 * @eid: element ID 6767 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6768 * @len: length of data 6769 * 6770 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 6771 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6772 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 6773 * requested element struct. 6774 * 6775 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6776 * having to fit into the given data. 6777 */ 6778 static inline const struct element * 6779 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 6780 { 6781 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 6782 } 6783 6784 /** 6785 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data 6786 * 6787 * @eid: element ID 6788 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6789 * @len: length of data 6790 * 6791 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 6792 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6793 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 6794 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 6795 * 6796 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6797 * having to fit into the given data. 6798 */ 6799 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 6800 { 6801 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 6802 } 6803 6804 /** 6805 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data 6806 * 6807 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 6808 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6809 * @len: length of data 6810 * 6811 * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if 6812 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6813 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 6814 * requested element struct. 6815 * 6816 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6817 * having to fit into the given data. 6818 */ 6819 static inline const struct element * 6820 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 6821 { 6822 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 6823 &ext_eid, 1, 0); 6824 } 6825 6826 /** 6827 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data 6828 * 6829 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 6830 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6831 * @len: length of data 6832 * 6833 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if 6834 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6835 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 6836 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 6837 * 6838 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6839 * having to fit into the given data. 6840 */ 6841 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 6842 { 6843 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 6844 &ext_eid, 1, 2); 6845 } 6846 6847 /** 6848 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data 6849 * 6850 * @oui: vendor OUI 6851 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 6852 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6853 * @len: length of data 6854 * 6855 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 6856 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise 6857 * return the element structure for the requested element. 6858 * 6859 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 6860 * the given data. 6861 */ 6862 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 6863 const u8 *ies, 6864 unsigned int len); 6865 6866 /** 6867 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data 6868 * 6869 * @oui: vendor OUI 6870 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 6871 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6872 * @len: length of data 6873 * 6874 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 6875 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to 6876 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 6877 * element ID. 6878 * 6879 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 6880 * the given data. 6881 */ 6882 static inline const u8 * 6883 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 6884 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len) 6885 { 6886 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len); 6887 } 6888 6889 /** 6890 * enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret - reduced neighbor report iteration state 6891 * @RNR_ITER_CONTINUE: continue iterating with the next entry 6892 * @RNR_ITER_BREAK: break iteration and return success 6893 * @RNR_ITER_ERROR: break iteration and return error 6894 */ 6895 enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret { 6896 RNR_ITER_CONTINUE, 6897 RNR_ITER_BREAK, 6898 RNR_ITER_ERROR, 6899 }; 6900 6901 /** 6902 * cfg80211_iter_rnr - iterate reduced neighbor report entries 6903 * @elems: the frame elements to iterate RNR elements and then 6904 * their entries in 6905 * @elems_len: length of the elements 6906 * @iter: iteration function, see also &enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret 6907 * for the return value 6908 * @iter_data: additional data passed to the iteration function 6909 * Return: %true on success (after successfully iterating all entries 6910 * or if the iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_BREAK), 6911 * %false on error (iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_ERROR 6912 * or elements were malformed.) 6913 */ 6914 bool cfg80211_iter_rnr(const u8 *elems, size_t elems_len, 6915 enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret 6916 (*iter)(void *data, u8 type, 6917 const struct ieee80211_neighbor_ap_info *info, 6918 const u8 *tbtt_info, u8 tbtt_info_len), 6919 void *iter_data); 6920 6921 /** 6922 * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer 6923 * 6924 * @elem: the element to defragment 6925 * @ies: elements where @elem is contained 6926 * @ieslen: length of @ies 6927 * @data: buffer to store element data, or %NULL to just determine size 6928 * @data_len: length of @data, or 0 6929 * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments 6930 * 6931 * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error 6932 * 6933 * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while 6934 * skipping all headers. 6935 * 6936 * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an 6937 * element in-place. 6938 */ 6939 ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies, 6940 size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len, 6941 u8 frag_id); 6942 6943 /** 6944 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame 6945 * 6946 * @dev: network device 6947 * @addr: STA MAC address 6948 * 6949 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge 6950 * devices upon STA association. 6951 */ 6952 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 6953 6954 /** 6955 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure 6956 * 6957 * TODO 6958 */ 6959 6960 /** 6961 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain 6962 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting 6963 * conflicts) 6964 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain 6965 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you 6966 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted 6967 * alpha2. 6968 * 6969 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core 6970 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by 6971 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory 6972 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain. 6973 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried 6974 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country. 6975 * 6976 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call. 6977 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(), 6978 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw(). 6979 * 6980 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6981 * an -ENOMEM. 6982 * 6983 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM. 6984 */ 6985 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2); 6986 6987 /** 6988 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers 6989 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6990 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy 6991 * 6992 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they 6993 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more 6994 * information. 6995 * 6996 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 6997 */ 6998 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6999 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 7000 7001 /** 7002 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers 7003 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 7004 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy 7005 * 7006 * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and 7007 * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details 7008 * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(). 7009 * 7010 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 7011 */ 7012 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7013 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 7014 7015 /** 7016 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain 7017 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 7018 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy 7019 * 7020 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply 7021 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory 7022 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The 7023 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous 7024 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a 7025 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled. 7026 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag 7027 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy 7028 * that called this helper. 7029 */ 7030 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7031 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd); 7032 7033 /** 7034 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency 7035 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for 7036 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for 7037 * 7038 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on 7039 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain 7040 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received 7041 * and processed already. 7042 * 7043 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule 7044 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to 7045 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return 7046 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even 7047 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band. 7048 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is 7049 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific. 7050 */ 7051 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7052 u32 center_freq); 7053 7054 /** 7055 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name 7056 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator 7057 * 7058 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a 7059 * proper string representation. 7060 * 7061 * Return: pointer to string representation of the initiator 7062 */ 7063 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator); 7064 7065 /** 7066 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom 7067 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked. 7068 * 7069 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI). 7070 * 7071 * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise 7072 */ 7073 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7074 7075 /** 7076 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions 7077 * 7078 */ 7079 7080 /** 7081 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule 7082 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively 7083 * 7084 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried. 7085 * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried. 7086 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db. 7087 * 7088 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query 7089 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given 7090 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations. 7091 * 7092 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 7093 * an -ENODATA. 7094 * 7095 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA. 7096 */ 7097 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq, 7098 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule); 7099 7100 /* 7101 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification 7102 * functions and BSS handling helpers 7103 */ 7104 7105 /** 7106 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished 7107 * 7108 * @request: the corresponding scan request 7109 * @info: information about the completed scan 7110 */ 7111 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request, 7112 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 7113 7114 /** 7115 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available 7116 * 7117 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results 7118 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 7119 */ 7120 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 7121 7122 /** 7123 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 7124 * 7125 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 7126 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 7127 * 7128 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 7129 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 7130 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 7131 */ 7132 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 7133 7134 /** 7135 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 7136 * 7137 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 7138 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 7139 * 7140 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 7141 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 7142 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 7143 * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held. 7144 */ 7145 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 7146 7147 /** 7148 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame 7149 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 7150 * @data: the BSS metadata 7151 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon) 7152 * @len: length of the management frame 7153 * @gfp: context flags 7154 * 7155 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 7156 * the BSS should be updated/added. 7157 * 7158 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 7159 * Or %NULL on error. 7160 */ 7161 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 7162 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7163 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 7164 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 7165 gfp_t gfp); 7166 7167 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 7168 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7169 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 7170 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 7171 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 7172 { 7173 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 7174 .chan = rx_channel, 7175 .signal = signal, 7176 }; 7177 7178 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 7179 } 7180 7181 /** 7182 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID 7183 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID 7184 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element 7185 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element 7186 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID 7187 */ 7188 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid, 7189 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid) 7190 { 7191 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid); 7192 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0); 7193 u64 new_bssid_u64; 7194 7195 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask; 7196 7197 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask; 7198 7199 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid); 7200 } 7201 7202 /** 7203 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited 7204 * @element: element to check 7205 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element 7206 * 7207 * Return: %true if should be inherited, %false otherwise 7208 */ 7209 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element, 7210 const struct element *non_inherit_element); 7211 7212 /** 7213 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs 7214 * @ie: ies 7215 * @ielen: length of IEs 7216 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element 7217 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile) 7218 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile 7219 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length 7220 * 7221 * Return: the number of bytes merged 7222 */ 7223 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 7224 const struct element *mbssid_elem, 7225 const struct element *sub_elem, 7226 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len); 7227 7228 /** 7229 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from 7230 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is 7231 * from a beacon or probe response 7232 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon 7233 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response 7234 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON: data comes from an S1G beacon 7235 */ 7236 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type { 7237 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN, 7238 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON, 7239 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP, 7240 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON, 7241 }; 7242 7243 /** 7244 * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies 7245 * @ie: IEs 7246 * @ielen: length of IEs 7247 * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel 7248 * 7249 * Return: the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined. 7250 */ 7251 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 7252 enum nl80211_band band); 7253 7254 /** 7255 * cfg80211_ssid_eq - compare two SSIDs 7256 * @a: first SSID 7257 * @b: second SSID 7258 * 7259 * Return: %true if SSIDs are equal, %false otherwise. 7260 */ 7261 static inline bool 7262 cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid *a, struct cfg80211_ssid *b) 7263 { 7264 if (WARN_ON(!a || !b)) 7265 return false; 7266 if (a->ssid_len != b->ssid_len) 7267 return false; 7268 return memcmp(a->ssid, b->ssid, a->ssid_len) ? false : true; 7269 } 7270 7271 /** 7272 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS 7273 * 7274 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 7275 * @data: the BSS metadata 7276 * @ftype: frame type (if known) 7277 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS 7278 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0) 7279 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer 7280 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer 7281 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer 7282 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs 7283 * @gfp: context flags 7284 * 7285 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 7286 * the BSS should be updated/added. 7287 * 7288 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 7289 * Or %NULL on error. 7290 */ 7291 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 7292 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7293 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 7294 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 7295 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 7296 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 7297 gfp_t gfp); 7298 7299 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 7300 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7301 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 7302 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 7303 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 7304 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 7305 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 7306 { 7307 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 7308 .chan = rx_channel, 7309 .signal = signal, 7310 }; 7311 7312 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 7313 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 7314 gfp); 7315 } 7316 7317 /** 7318 * __cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference 7319 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 7320 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) 7321 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) 7322 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) 7323 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) 7324 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type 7325 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy 7326 * @use_for: indicates which use is intended 7327 * 7328 * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error. 7329 */ 7330 struct cfg80211_bss *__cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7331 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 7332 const u8 *bssid, 7333 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 7334 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, 7335 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy, 7336 u32 use_for); 7337 7338 /** 7339 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference 7340 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 7341 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) 7342 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) 7343 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) 7344 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) 7345 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type 7346 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy 7347 * 7348 * This version implies regular usage, %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL. 7349 * 7350 * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error. 7351 */ 7352 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * 7353 cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 7354 const u8 *bssid, const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 7355 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, 7356 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy) 7357 { 7358 return __cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, bssid, ssid, ssid_len, 7359 bss_type, privacy, 7360 NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL); 7361 } 7362 7363 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * 7364 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7365 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 7366 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len) 7367 { 7368 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len, 7369 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 7370 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY); 7371 } 7372 7373 /** 7374 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct 7375 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 7376 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference 7377 * 7378 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct. 7379 */ 7380 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 7381 7382 /** 7383 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct 7384 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 7385 * @bss: the BSS struct 7386 * 7387 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct. 7388 */ 7389 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 7390 7391 /** 7392 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures 7393 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7394 * @bss: the bss to remove 7395 * 7396 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures 7397 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this 7398 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time 7399 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all. 7400 */ 7401 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 7402 7403 /** 7404 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries 7405 * 7406 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy 7407 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not 7408 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB. 7409 * 7410 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7411 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel 7412 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel. 7413 * @iter: the iterator function to call 7414 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function 7415 */ 7416 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7417 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7418 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7419 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 7420 void *data), 7421 void *iter_data); 7422 7423 /** 7424 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame 7425 * @dev: network device 7426 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body) 7427 * @len: length of the frame data 7428 * 7429 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or 7430 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode. 7431 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must 7432 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 7433 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 7434 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 7435 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed 7436 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used 7437 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function 7438 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead. 7439 * 7440 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 7441 */ 7442 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 7443 7444 /** 7445 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication 7446 * @dev: network device 7447 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out 7448 * 7449 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's 7450 * mutex. 7451 */ 7452 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 7453 7454 /** 7455 * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data 7456 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body) 7457 * @len: length of the frame data 7458 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format 7459 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 7460 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame 7461 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data 7462 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO) 7463 * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for 7464 * non-MLO connections 7465 * @links.bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the 7466 * pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp() 7467 * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that 7468 * were rejected by the AP. 7469 */ 7470 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data { 7471 const u8 *buf; 7472 size_t len; 7473 const u8 *req_ies; 7474 size_t req_ies_len; 7475 int uapsd_queues; 7476 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 7477 struct { 7478 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 7479 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 7480 u16 status; 7481 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 7482 }; 7483 7484 /** 7485 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response 7486 * @dev: network device 7487 * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data 7488 * 7489 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 7490 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 7491 * 7492 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 7493 */ 7494 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev, 7495 const struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data); 7496 7497 /** 7498 * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data 7499 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL 7500 * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections 7501 * (@ap_mld_addr is %NULL) 7502 * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise 7503 * the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some 7504 * other API (e.g. deauth RX) 7505 */ 7506 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure { 7507 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 7508 struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 7509 bool timeout; 7510 }; 7511 7512 /** 7513 * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure 7514 * @dev: network device 7515 * @data: data describing the association failure 7516 * 7517 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 7518 */ 7519 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev, 7520 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data); 7521 7522 /** 7523 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame 7524 * @dev: network device 7525 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body) 7526 * @len: length of the frame data 7527 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute) 7528 * 7529 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in 7530 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and 7531 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the 7532 * corresponding wdev's mutex. 7533 */ 7534 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 7535 bool reconnect); 7536 7537 /** 7538 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame 7539 * @dev: network device 7540 * @buf: received management frame (header + body) 7541 * @len: length of the frame data 7542 * 7543 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc 7544 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the 7545 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon 7546 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while 7547 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). 7548 * 7549 * This function may sleep. 7550 */ 7551 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, 7552 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 7553 7554 /** 7555 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP) 7556 * @dev: network device 7557 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame 7558 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used 7559 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing. 7560 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets) 7561 * @gfp: allocation flags 7562 * 7563 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a 7564 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() 7565 * primitive. 7566 */ 7567 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 7568 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id, 7569 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp); 7570 7571 /** 7572 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS 7573 * 7574 * @dev: network device 7575 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined 7576 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined 7577 * @gfp: allocation flags 7578 * 7579 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or 7580 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called, 7581 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of 7582 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called 7583 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is 7584 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest. 7585 */ 7586 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7587 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp); 7588 7589 /** 7590 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer 7591 * candidate 7592 * 7593 * @dev: network device 7594 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate 7595 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate 7596 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer 7597 * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm 7598 * @gfp: allocation flags 7599 * 7600 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been 7601 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response. 7602 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace. 7603 */ 7604 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev, 7605 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len, 7606 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp); 7607 7608 /** 7609 * DOC: RFkill integration 7610 * 7611 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers, 7612 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each 7613 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated 7614 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off. Drivers are 7615 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down. 7616 * 7617 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they 7618 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211. 7619 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here. 7620 */ 7621 7622 /** 7623 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state 7624 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7625 * @blocked: block status 7626 * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons 7627 */ 7628 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked, 7629 enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason); 7630 7631 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked) 7632 { 7633 wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked, 7634 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL); 7635 } 7636 7637 /** 7638 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill 7639 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7640 */ 7641 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7642 7643 /** 7644 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill 7645 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7646 */ 7647 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy) 7648 { 7649 rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill); 7650 } 7651 7652 /** 7653 * DOC: Vendor commands 7654 * 7655 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that 7656 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the 7657 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with 7658 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as 7659 * the configuration mechanism. 7660 * 7661 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array 7662 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one. Each command has an 7663 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it. 7664 * 7665 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol 7666 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular, 7667 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any 7668 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection 7669 * managers etc. need. 7670 */ 7671 7672 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7673 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 7674 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 7675 int approxlen); 7676 7677 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7678 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7679 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 7680 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 7681 unsigned int portid, 7682 int vendor_event_idx, 7683 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp); 7684 7685 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp); 7686 7687 /** 7688 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply 7689 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7690 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7691 * be put into the skb 7692 * 7693 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 7694 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 7695 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid. 7696 * 7697 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in 7698 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 7699 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 7700 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 7701 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 7702 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute. 7703 * You must not modify the skb in any other way. 7704 * 7705 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return 7706 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation. 7707 * 7708 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7709 */ 7710 static inline struct sk_buff * 7711 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 7712 { 7713 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 7714 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen); 7715 } 7716 7717 /** 7718 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb 7719 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 7720 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb() 7721 * 7722 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 7723 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should 7724 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the 7725 * skb regardless of the return value. 7726 * 7727 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 7728 */ 7729 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb); 7730 7731 /** 7732 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID 7733 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7734 * 7735 * Return: the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler. 7736 * 7737 * Context: May only be called from a vendor command handler 7738 */ 7739 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7740 7741 /** 7742 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb 7743 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7744 * @wdev: the wireless device 7745 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 7746 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7747 * be put into the skb 7748 * @gfp: allocation flags 7749 * 7750 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 7751 * vendor-specific multicast group. 7752 * 7753 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 7754 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 7755 * attribute. 7756 * 7757 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 7758 * skb to send the event. 7759 * 7760 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7761 */ 7762 static inline struct sk_buff * 7763 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7764 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 7765 { 7766 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 7767 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 7768 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 7769 } 7770 7771 /** 7772 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb 7773 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7774 * @wdev: the wireless device 7775 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 7776 * @portid: port ID of the receiver 7777 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7778 * be put into the skb 7779 * @gfp: allocation flags 7780 * 7781 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to 7782 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been 7783 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take 7784 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes. 7785 * 7786 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 7787 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 7788 * attribute. 7789 * 7790 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 7791 * skb to send the event. 7792 * 7793 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7794 */ 7795 static inline struct sk_buff * 7796 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7797 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7798 unsigned int portid, int approxlen, 7799 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 7800 { 7801 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 7802 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 7803 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 7804 } 7805 7806 /** 7807 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event 7808 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc() 7809 * @gfp: allocation flags 7810 * 7811 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 7812 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it. 7813 */ 7814 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 7815 { 7816 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 7817 } 7818 7819 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 7820 /** 7821 * DOC: Test mode 7822 * 7823 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to 7824 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance, 7825 * factory programming. 7826 * 7827 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it. For more 7828 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it. 7829 */ 7830 7831 /** 7832 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply 7833 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7834 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7835 * be put into the skb 7836 * 7837 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 7838 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 7839 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid. 7840 * 7841 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in 7842 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 7843 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 7844 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 7845 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 7846 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You 7847 * must not modify the skb in any other way. 7848 * 7849 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return 7850 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation. 7851 * 7852 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7853 */ 7854 static inline struct sk_buff * 7855 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 7856 { 7857 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 7858 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen); 7859 } 7860 7861 /** 7862 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb 7863 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 7864 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() 7865 * 7866 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 7867 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return 7868 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb 7869 * regardless of the return value. 7870 * 7871 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 7872 */ 7873 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb) 7874 { 7875 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb); 7876 } 7877 7878 /** 7879 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event 7880 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7881 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7882 * be put into the skb 7883 * @gfp: allocation flags 7884 * 7885 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 7886 * testmode multicast group. 7887 * 7888 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with 7889 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As 7890 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the 7891 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb 7892 * in any other way. 7893 * 7894 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the 7895 * skb to send the event. 7896 * 7897 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7898 */ 7899 static inline struct sk_buff * 7900 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp) 7901 { 7902 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 7903 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1, 7904 approxlen, gfp); 7905 } 7906 7907 /** 7908 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event 7909 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 7910 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb() 7911 * @gfp: allocation flags 7912 * 7913 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 7914 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always 7915 * consumes it. 7916 */ 7917 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 7918 { 7919 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 7920 } 7921 7922 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd), 7923 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd), 7924 #else 7925 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) 7926 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) 7927 #endif 7928 7929 /** 7930 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params 7931 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL) 7932 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets 7933 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in 7934 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid. 7935 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in 7936 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the 7937 * status for a FILS connection. 7938 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL). 7939 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets 7940 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID 7941 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL). 7942 */ 7943 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params { 7944 const u8 *kek; 7945 size_t kek_len; 7946 bool update_erp_next_seq_num; 7947 u16 erp_next_seq_num; 7948 const u8 *pmk; 7949 size_t pmk_len; 7950 const u8 *pmkid; 7951 }; 7952 7953 /** 7954 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params 7955 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7956 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7957 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 7958 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 7959 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 7960 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 7961 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 7962 * case. 7963 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL) 7964 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length 7965 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7966 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length 7967 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters. 7968 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 7969 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 7970 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 7971 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 7972 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 7973 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 7974 * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise 7975 * zero. 7976 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL. 7977 * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated 7978 * using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the 7979 * connected AP info. 7980 * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise 7981 * %NULL. 7982 * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO 7983 * connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL). 7984 * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected. 7985 * For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA 7986 * is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be 7987 * %NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and 7988 * hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning 7989 * if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers 7990 * implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs 7991 * to be specified. 7992 * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not 7993 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the 7994 * @valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released) 7995 */ 7996 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params { 7997 int status; 7998 const u8 *req_ie; 7999 size_t req_ie_len; 8000 const u8 *resp_ie; 8001 size_t resp_ie_len; 8002 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 8003 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason; 8004 8005 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 8006 u16 valid_links; 8007 struct { 8008 const u8 *addr; 8009 const u8 *bssid; 8010 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 8011 u16 status; 8012 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 8013 }; 8014 8015 /** 8016 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result 8017 * 8018 * @dev: network device 8019 * @params: connection response parameters 8020 * @gfp: allocation flags 8021 * 8022 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 8023 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 8024 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response 8025 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), 8026 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(), 8027 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 8028 */ 8029 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev, 8030 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params, 8031 gfp_t gfp); 8032 8033 /** 8034 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result 8035 * 8036 * @dev: network device 8037 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 8038 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 8039 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 8040 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 8041 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 8042 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 8043 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 8044 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 8045 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 8046 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 8047 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 8048 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 8049 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 8050 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 8051 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 8052 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 8053 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 8054 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 8055 * case. 8056 * @gfp: allocation flags 8057 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 8058 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 8059 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 8060 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 8061 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 8062 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 8063 * 8064 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 8065 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 8066 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss 8067 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among 8068 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 8069 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 8070 */ 8071 static inline void 8072 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 8073 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie, 8074 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie, 8075 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp, 8076 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 8077 { 8078 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params; 8079 8080 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params)); 8081 params.status = status; 8082 params.links[0].bssid = bssid; 8083 params.links[0].bss = bss; 8084 params.req_ie = req_ie; 8085 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len; 8086 params.resp_ie = resp_ie; 8087 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len; 8088 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason; 8089 8090 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp); 8091 } 8092 8093 /** 8094 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result 8095 * 8096 * @dev: network device 8097 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 8098 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 8099 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 8100 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 8101 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 8102 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 8103 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 8104 * the real status code for failures. 8105 * @gfp: allocation flags 8106 * 8107 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 8108 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 8109 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only 8110 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 8111 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 8112 */ 8113 static inline void 8114 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 8115 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, 8116 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len, 8117 u16 status, gfp_t gfp) 8118 { 8119 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie, 8120 resp_ie_len, status, gfp, 8121 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED); 8122 } 8123 8124 /** 8125 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout 8126 * 8127 * @dev: network device 8128 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 8129 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 8130 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 8131 * @gfp: allocation flags 8132 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. 8133 * 8134 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed 8135 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was 8136 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send 8137 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while 8138 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among 8139 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 8140 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 8141 */ 8142 static inline void 8143 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 8144 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp, 8145 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 8146 { 8147 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1, 8148 gfp, timeout_reason); 8149 } 8150 8151 /** 8152 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information 8153 * 8154 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 8155 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 8156 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 8157 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 8158 * @fils: FILS related roaming information. 8159 * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set. 8160 * Otherwise zero. 8161 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL. 8162 * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in 8163 * @valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info. 8164 * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL. 8165 * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO 8166 * roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be 8167 * %NULL if %links.bss is set. 8168 * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP. 8169 * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got 8170 * roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to 8171 * which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set) 8172 */ 8173 struct cfg80211_roam_info { 8174 const u8 *req_ie; 8175 size_t req_ie_len; 8176 const u8 *resp_ie; 8177 size_t resp_ie_len; 8178 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 8179 8180 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 8181 u16 valid_links; 8182 struct { 8183 const u8 *addr; 8184 const u8 *bssid; 8185 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 8186 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 8187 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 8188 }; 8189 8190 /** 8191 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming 8192 * 8193 * @dev: network device 8194 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info. 8195 * @gfp: allocation flags 8196 * 8197 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the 8198 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry. 8199 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP 8200 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in 8201 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where 8202 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the 8203 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling 8204 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released 8205 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be 8206 * released while disconnecting from the current bss. 8207 */ 8208 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info, 8209 gfp_t gfp); 8210 8211 /** 8212 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association 8213 * 8214 * @dev: network device 8215 * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address 8216 * in case of AP/P2P GO 8217 * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy 8218 * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy 8219 * @gfp: allocation flags 8220 * 8221 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake 8222 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e., 8223 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function 8224 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(), 8225 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to 8226 * indicate the 802.11 association. 8227 * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports 8228 * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of 8229 * associated STA/GC. 8230 */ 8231 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr, 8232 const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp); 8233 8234 /** 8235 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped 8236 * 8237 * @dev: network device 8238 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL) 8239 * @ie_len: length of IEs 8240 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown 8241 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally 8242 * @gfp: allocation flags 8243 * 8244 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state 8245 * and not try to connect to any AP any more. 8246 */ 8247 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason, 8248 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len, 8249 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp); 8250 8251 /** 8252 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start 8253 * @wdev: wireless device 8254 * @cookie: the request cookie 8255 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 8256 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the 8257 * channel 8258 * @gfp: allocation flags 8259 */ 8260 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 8261 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 8262 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp); 8263 8264 /** 8265 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 8266 * @wdev: wireless device 8267 * @cookie: the request cookie 8268 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 8269 * @gfp: allocation flags 8270 */ 8271 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 8272 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 8273 gfp_t gfp); 8274 8275 /** 8276 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired 8277 * @wdev: wireless device 8278 * @cookie: the requested cookie 8279 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request) 8280 * @gfp: allocation flags 8281 */ 8282 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 8283 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp); 8284 8285 /** 8286 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics. 8287 * 8288 * @sinfo: the station information 8289 * @gfp: allocation flags 8290 * 8291 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 8292 */ 8293 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 8294 8295 /** 8296 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info 8297 * @sinfo: the station information 8298 * 8299 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station 8300 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on 8301 * the stack.) 8302 */ 8303 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo) 8304 { 8305 kfree(sinfo->pertid); 8306 } 8307 8308 /** 8309 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station 8310 * 8311 * @dev: the netdev 8312 * @mac_addr: the station's address 8313 * @sinfo: the station information 8314 * @gfp: allocation flags 8315 */ 8316 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 8317 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 8318 8319 /** 8320 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station 8321 * @dev: the netdev 8322 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used. 8323 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics 8324 * @gfp: allocation flags 8325 */ 8326 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 8327 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 8328 8329 /** 8330 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station 8331 * 8332 * @dev: the netdev 8333 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used. 8334 * @gfp: allocation flags 8335 */ 8336 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev, 8337 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp) 8338 { 8339 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp); 8340 } 8341 8342 /** 8343 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification 8344 * 8345 * @dev: the netdev 8346 * @mac_addr: the station's address 8347 * @reason: the reason for connection failure 8348 * @gfp: allocation flags 8349 * 8350 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station 8351 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection 8352 * for some reasons, this function is called. 8353 * 8354 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from 8355 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum 8356 */ 8357 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 8358 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason, 8359 gfp_t gfp); 8360 8361 /** 8362 * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info 8363 * 8364 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz 8365 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8366 * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of 8367 * an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid 8368 * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received on 8369 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8370 * @len: length of the frame data 8371 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 8372 * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds 8373 * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds 8374 */ 8375 struct cfg80211_rx_info { 8376 int freq; 8377 int sig_dbm; 8378 bool have_link_id; 8379 u8 link_id; 8380 const u8 *buf; 8381 size_t len; 8382 u32 flags; 8383 u64 rx_tstamp; 8384 u64 ack_tstamp; 8385 }; 8386 8387 /** 8388 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info 8389 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8390 * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info 8391 * 8392 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 8393 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 8394 * 8395 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 8396 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 8397 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 8398 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 8399 */ 8400 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8401 struct cfg80211_rx_info *info); 8402 8403 /** 8404 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 8405 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8406 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz 8407 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8408 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8409 * @len: length of the frame data 8410 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 8411 * 8412 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 8413 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 8414 * 8415 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 8416 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 8417 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 8418 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 8419 */ 8420 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, 8421 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 8422 u32 flags) 8423 { 8424 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = { 8425 .freq = freq, 8426 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm, 8427 .buf = buf, 8428 .len = len, 8429 .flags = flags 8430 }; 8431 8432 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info); 8433 } 8434 8435 /** 8436 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 8437 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8438 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz 8439 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8440 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8441 * @len: length of the frame data 8442 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 8443 * 8444 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 8445 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 8446 * 8447 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 8448 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 8449 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 8450 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 8451 */ 8452 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, 8453 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 8454 u32 flags) 8455 { 8456 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = { 8457 .freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), 8458 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm, 8459 .buf = buf, 8460 .len = len, 8461 .flags = flags 8462 }; 8463 8464 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info); 8465 } 8466 8467 /** 8468 * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information 8469 * 8470 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() 8471 * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds 8472 * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds 8473 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8474 * @len: length of the frame data 8475 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 8476 */ 8477 struct cfg80211_tx_status { 8478 u64 cookie; 8479 u64 tx_tstamp; 8480 u64 ack_tstamp; 8481 const u8 *buf; 8482 size_t len; 8483 bool ack; 8484 }; 8485 8486 /** 8487 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info 8488 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8489 * @status: TX status data 8490 * @gfp: context flags 8491 * 8492 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be 8493 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the 8494 * transmission attempt with extended info. 8495 */ 8496 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8497 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp); 8498 8499 /** 8500 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame 8501 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8502 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() 8503 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8504 * @len: length of the frame data 8505 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 8506 * @gfp: context flags 8507 * 8508 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be 8509 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the 8510 * transmission attempt. 8511 */ 8512 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8513 u64 cookie, const u8 *buf, 8514 size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp) 8515 { 8516 struct cfg80211_tx_status status = { 8517 .cookie = cookie, 8518 .buf = buf, 8519 .len = len, 8520 .ack = ack 8521 }; 8522 8523 cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp); 8524 } 8525 8526 /** 8527 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control 8528 * port frames 8529 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8530 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() 8531 * @buf: Data frame (header + body) 8532 * @len: length of the frame data 8533 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 8534 * @gfp: context flags 8535 * 8536 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be 8537 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of 8538 * the transmission attempt. 8539 */ 8540 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 8541 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, 8542 gfp_t gfp); 8543 8544 /** 8545 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame 8546 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 8547 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf 8548 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear. 8549 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is 8550 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that 8551 * skb->protocol is set appropriately. 8552 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted 8553 * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown 8554 * 8555 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port 8556 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive 8557 * control port frames over nl80211. 8558 * 8559 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all 8560 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame). 8561 * 8562 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace 8563 */ 8564 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb, 8565 bool unencrypted, int link_id); 8566 8567 /** 8568 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event 8569 * @dev: network device 8570 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event 8571 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 8572 * @gfp: context flags 8573 * 8574 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring 8575 * rssi threshold reached event occurs. 8576 */ 8577 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8578 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 8579 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp); 8580 8581 /** 8582 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer 8583 * @dev: network device 8584 * @peer: peer's MAC address 8585 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold 8586 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent 8587 * threshold (to account for temporary interference) 8588 * @gfp: context flags 8589 */ 8590 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8591 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp); 8592 8593 /** 8594 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event 8595 * @dev: network device 8596 * @peer: peer's MAC address 8597 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost 8598 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission 8599 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached. 8600 * @gfp: context flags 8601 * 8602 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a 8603 * given interval is exceeded. 8604 */ 8605 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 8606 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp); 8607 8608 /** 8609 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event 8610 * @dev: network device 8611 * @gfp: context flags 8612 * 8613 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP. 8614 */ 8615 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp); 8616 8617 /** 8618 * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event 8619 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8620 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 8621 * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain 8622 * @gfp: context flags 8623 * 8624 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl. 8625 */ 8626 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8627 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8628 bool offchan, gfp_t gfp); 8629 8630 static inline void 8631 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8632 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8633 gfp_t gfp) 8634 { 8635 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp); 8636 } 8637 8638 static inline void 8639 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8640 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8641 gfp_t gfp) 8642 { 8643 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp); 8644 } 8645 8646 /** 8647 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event 8648 * @dev: network device 8649 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified 8650 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value 8651 * @gfp: context flags 8652 * 8653 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action 8654 * frame. 8655 */ 8656 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac, 8657 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode, 8658 gfp_t gfp); 8659 8660 /** 8661 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event 8662 * @netdev: network device 8663 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 8664 * @event: type of event 8665 * @gfp: context flags 8666 * 8667 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished 8668 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process, 8669 * also by full-MAC drivers. 8670 */ 8671 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev, 8672 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8673 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp); 8674 8675 /** 8676 * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event 8677 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8678 * 8679 * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check 8680 * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain. 8681 */ 8682 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8683 8684 /** 8685 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying 8686 * @dev: network device 8687 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races) 8688 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter 8689 * @gfp: allocation flags 8690 */ 8691 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 8692 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 8693 8694 /** 8695 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate 8696 * @dev: network device 8697 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority) 8698 * @bssid: BSSID of AP 8699 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication 8700 * @gfp: allocation flags 8701 */ 8702 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index, 8703 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp); 8704 8705 /** 8706 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame 8707 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 8708 * @addr: the transmitter address 8709 * @gfp: context flags 8710 * 8711 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 8712 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the 8713 * sender. 8714 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 8715 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 8716 */ 8717 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev, 8718 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 8719 8720 /** 8721 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame 8722 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 8723 * @addr: the transmitter address 8724 * @gfp: context flags 8725 * 8726 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 8727 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected. 8728 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each 8729 * station to avoid event flooding. 8730 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 8731 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 8732 */ 8733 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev, 8734 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 8735 8736 /** 8737 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status 8738 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on 8739 * @addr: the address of the peer 8740 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously 8741 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not 8742 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame. 8743 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not. 8744 * @gfp: allocation flags 8745 */ 8746 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 8747 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal, 8748 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp); 8749 8750 /** 8751 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs 8752 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 8753 * @frame: the frame 8754 * @len: length of the frame 8755 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz 8756 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8757 * 8758 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 8759 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 8760 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 8761 */ 8762 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame, 8763 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm); 8764 8765 /** 8766 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs 8767 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 8768 * @frame: the frame 8769 * @len: length of the frame 8770 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on 8771 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8772 * 8773 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 8774 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 8775 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 8776 */ 8777 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8778 const u8 *frame, size_t len, 8779 int freq, int sig_dbm) 8780 { 8781 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), 8782 sig_dbm); 8783 } 8784 8785 /** 8786 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed 8787 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8788 * @chandef: the channel definition 8789 * @iftype: interface type 8790 * 8791 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 8792 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.) 8793 */ 8794 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8795 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8796 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 8797 8798 /** 8799 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation 8800 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8801 * @chandef: the channel definition 8802 * @iftype: interface type 8803 * 8804 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 8805 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version 8806 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under 8807 * more permissive conditions. 8808 * 8809 * Context: Requires the wiphy mutex to be held. 8810 */ 8811 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8812 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8813 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 8814 8815 /** 8816 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace 8817 * @dev: the device which switched channels 8818 * @chandef: the new channel definition 8819 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO 8820 * 8821 * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable 8822 * driver context! 8823 */ 8824 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8825 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8826 unsigned int link_id); 8827 8828 /** 8829 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start 8830 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started 8831 * @chandef: the future channel definition 8832 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO 8833 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens 8834 * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP 8835 * 8836 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just 8837 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting 8838 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary. 8839 */ 8840 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8841 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8842 unsigned int link_id, u8 count, 8843 bool quiet); 8844 8845 /** 8846 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band 8847 * 8848 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert 8849 * @band: band pointer to fill 8850 * 8851 * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 8852 */ 8853 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class, 8854 enum nl80211_band *band); 8855 8856 /** 8857 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef - convert operating class to chandef 8858 * 8859 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert 8860 * @chan: the ieee80211_channel to convert 8861 * @chandef: a pointer to the resulting chandef 8862 * 8863 * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 8864 */ 8865 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef(u8 operating_class, 8866 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 8867 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 8868 8869 /** 8870 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class 8871 * 8872 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 8873 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class 8874 * 8875 * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 8876 */ 8877 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8878 u8 *op_class); 8879 8880 /** 8881 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz 8882 * 8883 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 8884 * 8885 * Return: the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz. 8886 */ 8887 static inline u32 8888 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 8889 { 8890 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset; 8891 } 8892 8893 /** 8894 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation 8895 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested 8896 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device 8897 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or 8898 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN) 8899 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request 8900 * @gfp: allocation flags 8901 * 8902 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that 8903 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP 8904 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use 8905 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g., 8906 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer). 8907 */ 8908 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 8909 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 8910 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 8911 8912 /** 8913 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units) 8914 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from 8915 * 8916 * Return: calculated bitrate 8917 */ 8918 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate); 8919 8920 /** 8921 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev 8922 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove 8923 * 8924 * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary 8925 * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device 8926 * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called 8927 * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device 8928 * is unbound from the driver. 8929 * 8930 * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 8931 */ 8932 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 8933 8934 /** 8935 * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev 8936 * @dev: the netdev to register 8937 * 8938 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather 8939 * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is 8940 * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable 8941 * instead as well. 8942 * 8943 * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 8944 * 8945 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 8946 */ 8947 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev); 8948 8949 /** 8950 * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev 8951 * @dev: the netdev to register 8952 * 8953 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather 8954 * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL 8955 * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are 8956 * usable instead as well. 8957 * 8958 * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 8959 */ 8960 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev) 8961 { 8962 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) 8963 cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr); 8964 #endif 8965 } 8966 8967 /** 8968 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements 8969 * @ies: FT IEs 8970 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes 8971 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address 8972 * @ric_ies: RIC IE 8973 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes 8974 */ 8975 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params { 8976 const u8 *ies; 8977 size_t ies_len; 8978 const u8 *target_ap; 8979 const u8 *ric_ies; 8980 size_t ric_ies_len; 8981 }; 8982 8983 /** 8984 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE 8985 * @netdev: network device 8986 * @ft_event: IE information 8987 */ 8988 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev, 8989 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event); 8990 8991 /** 8992 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer 8993 * @ies: the input IE buffer 8994 * @len: the input length 8995 * @attr: the attribute ID to find 8996 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g. 8997 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size 8998 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer 8999 * 9000 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and 9001 * copies its contents to the given buffer. 9002 * 9003 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is 9004 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the 9005 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero). 9006 */ 9007 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 9008 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr, 9009 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize); 9010 9011 /** 9012 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC) 9013 * @ies: the IE buffer 9014 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 9015 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 9016 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 9017 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 9018 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 9019 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element 9020 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array 9021 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 9022 * 9023 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 9024 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 9025 * split. 9026 * 9027 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 9028 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 9029 * 9030 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 9031 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 9032 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 9033 * 9034 * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which 9035 * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be 9036 * used. 9037 */ 9038 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 9039 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, 9040 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric, 9041 size_t offset); 9042 9043 /** 9044 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering 9045 * @ies: the IE buffer 9046 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 9047 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 9048 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 9049 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 9050 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 9051 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 9052 * 9053 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 9054 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 9055 * split. 9056 * 9057 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 9058 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 9059 * 9060 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 9061 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 9062 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 9063 * 9064 * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which 9065 * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be 9066 * used. 9067 */ 9068 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 9069 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset) 9070 { 9071 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset); 9072 } 9073 9074 /** 9075 * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb 9076 * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to 9077 * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment 9078 * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments 9079 * 9080 * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation 9081 * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size 9082 * accordingly. 9083 */ 9084 void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id); 9085 9086 /** 9087 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN 9088 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup 9089 * @wakeup: the wakeup report 9090 * @gfp: allocation flags 9091 * 9092 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it 9093 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may 9094 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something 9095 * else caused the wakeup. 9096 */ 9097 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9098 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 9099 gfp_t gfp); 9100 9101 /** 9102 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver. 9103 * 9104 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped. 9105 * @gfp: allocation flags 9106 * 9107 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted 9108 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given 9109 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired. 9110 */ 9111 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp); 9112 9113 /** 9114 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has 9115 * @wiphy: the wiphy 9116 * 9117 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device. 9118 */ 9119 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy); 9120 9121 /** 9122 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations 9123 * 9124 * @wiphy: the wiphy 9125 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 9126 * 9127 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a 9128 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to 9129 * the interface combinations. 9130 * 9131 * Return: 0 if combinations are allowed. Non-zero on error. 9132 */ 9133 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 9134 struct iface_combination_params *params); 9135 9136 /** 9137 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations 9138 * 9139 * @wiphy: the wiphy 9140 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 9141 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination 9142 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function 9143 * 9144 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible 9145 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching 9146 * purposes. 9147 * 9148 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 9149 */ 9150 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 9151 struct iface_combination_params *params, 9152 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c, 9153 void *data), 9154 void *data); 9155 9156 /** 9157 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection 9158 * 9159 * @wiphy: the wiphy 9160 * @wdev: wireless device 9161 * @gfp: context flags 9162 * 9163 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA 9164 * disconnected. 9165 * 9166 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous. 9167 */ 9168 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9169 gfp_t gfp); 9170 9171 /** 9172 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy 9173 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down 9174 * 9175 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by 9176 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed). 9177 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors 9178 * that really can't be recovered in any other way. 9179 * 9180 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into 9181 * the driver while the function is running. 9182 */ 9183 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy); 9184 9185 /** 9186 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag 9187 * 9188 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 9189 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 9190 * 9191 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 9192 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 9193 */ 9194 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, 9195 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 9196 { 9197 u8 *ft_byte; 9198 9199 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 9200 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8); 9201 } 9202 9203 /** 9204 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag 9205 * 9206 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 9207 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 9208 * 9209 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 9210 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 9211 * 9212 * Return: %true if extended feature flag is set, %false otherwise 9213 */ 9214 static inline bool 9215 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy, 9216 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 9217 { 9218 u8 ft_byte; 9219 9220 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 9221 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0; 9222 } 9223 9224 /** 9225 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function 9226 * @f: NAN function that should be freed 9227 * 9228 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members. 9229 */ 9230 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f); 9231 9232 /** 9233 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters 9234 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is 9235 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber. 9236 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery 9237 * result. 9238 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up. 9239 * @inst_id: the local instance id 9240 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function 9241 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer 9242 * @info_len: the length of the &info 9243 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any) 9244 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function 9245 */ 9246 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params { 9247 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 9248 u8 inst_id; 9249 u8 peer_inst_id; 9250 const u8 *addr; 9251 u8 info_len; 9252 const u8 *info; 9253 u64 cookie; 9254 }; 9255 9256 /** 9257 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function. 9258 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 9259 * @match: match notification parameters 9260 * @gfp: allocation flags 9261 * 9262 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This 9263 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that 9264 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received. 9265 */ 9266 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9267 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp); 9268 9269 /** 9270 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 9271 * 9272 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 9273 * @inst_id: the local instance id 9274 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 9275 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier 9276 * @gfp: allocation flags 9277 * 9278 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated. 9279 */ 9280 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9281 u8 inst_id, 9282 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 9283 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp); 9284 9285 /* ethtool helper */ 9286 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info); 9287 9288 /** 9289 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication 9290 * @netdev: network device 9291 * @params: External authentication parameters 9292 * @gfp: allocation flags 9293 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error 9294 */ 9295 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev, 9296 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params, 9297 gfp_t gfp); 9298 9299 /** 9300 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data 9301 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 9302 * @req: the original measurement request 9303 * @result: the result data 9304 * @gfp: allocation flags 9305 */ 9306 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9307 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 9308 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result, 9309 gfp_t gfp); 9310 9311 /** 9312 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed 9313 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 9314 * @req: the original measurement request 9315 * @gfp: allocation flags 9316 * 9317 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this 9318 * the request pointer will no longer be valid. 9319 */ 9320 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9321 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 9322 gfp_t gfp); 9323 9324 /** 9325 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed 9326 * @wiphy: the wiphy 9327 * @iftype: interface type 9328 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1' 9329 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces 9330 * 9331 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API 9332 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when 9333 * check_swif is '1'. 9334 * 9335 * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise 9336 */ 9337 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 9338 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif); 9339 9340 9341 /** 9342 * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was 9343 * temporarily rejected with a comeback 9344 * @netdev: network device 9345 * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association 9346 * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs. 9347 * 9348 * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 9349 */ 9350 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev, 9351 const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout); 9352 9353 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */ 9354 9355 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */ 9356 9357 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \ 9358 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9359 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9360 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9361 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9362 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9363 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9364 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9365 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9366 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9367 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9368 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9369 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9370 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9371 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9372 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9373 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9374 dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9375 9376 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9377 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9378 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9379 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9380 9381 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9382 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args) 9383 9384 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9385 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9386 9387 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG) 9388 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg 9389 #else 9390 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9391 ({ \ 9392 if (0) \ 9393 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \ 9394 0; \ 9395 }) 9396 #endif 9397 9398 /* 9399 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference 9400 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the 9401 * file/line information and a backtrace. 9402 */ 9403 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9404 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args); 9405 9406 /** 9407 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space 9408 * @netdev: network device 9409 * @owe_info: peer's owe info 9410 * @gfp: allocation flags 9411 */ 9412 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev, 9413 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info, 9414 gfp_t gfp); 9415 9416 /** 9417 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries 9418 * @wiphy: the wiphy 9419 */ 9420 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy); 9421 9422 /** 9423 * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event 9424 * @dev: network device 9425 * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify 9426 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens 9427 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of 9428 * 9429 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 9430 */ 9431 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev, 9432 enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count, 9433 u64 color_bitmap); 9434 9435 /** 9436 * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision 9437 * @dev: network device 9438 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of 9439 * 9440 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 9441 */ 9442 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev, 9443 u64 color_bitmap) 9444 { 9445 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION, 9446 0, color_bitmap); 9447 } 9448 9449 /** 9450 * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start 9451 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched 9452 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens 9453 * 9454 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started. 9455 * 9456 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 9457 */ 9458 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 9459 u8 count) 9460 { 9461 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED, 9462 count, 0); 9463 } 9464 9465 /** 9466 * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort 9467 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched 9468 * 9469 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted. 9470 * 9471 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 9472 */ 9473 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev) 9474 { 9475 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED, 9476 0, 0); 9477 } 9478 9479 /** 9480 * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion 9481 * @dev: the device on which the color was switched 9482 * 9483 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed. 9484 * 9485 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 9486 */ 9487 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev) 9488 { 9489 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, 9490 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED, 9491 0, 0); 9492 } 9493 9494 /** 9495 * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links. 9496 * @dev: network device. 9497 * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs. 9498 * 9499 * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to 9500 * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link 9501 * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this 9502 * case disconnect instead. 9503 * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held. 9504 */ 9505 void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask); 9506 9507 /** 9508 * cfg80211_schedule_channels_check - schedule regulatory check if needed 9509 * @wdev: the wireless device to check 9510 * 9511 * In case the device supports NO_IR or DFS relaxations, schedule regulatory 9512 * channels check, as previous concurrent operation conditions may not 9513 * hold anymore. 9514 */ 9515 void cfg80211_schedule_channels_check(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 9516 9517 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS 9518 /** 9519 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs 9520 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use 9521 * @file: the file being read 9522 * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from 9523 * @bufsize: size of the buffer 9524 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to 9525 * @count: read count 9526 * @ppos: read position 9527 * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock) 9528 * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler 9529 * 9530 * Return: the number of characters read, or a negative errno 9531 */ 9532 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file, 9533 char *buf, size_t bufsize, 9534 char __user *userbuf, size_t count, 9535 loff_t *ppos, 9536 ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 9537 struct file *file, 9538 char *buf, 9539 size_t bufsize, 9540 void *data), 9541 void *data); 9542 9543 /** 9544 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs 9545 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use 9546 * @file: the file being written to 9547 * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to 9548 * @bufsize: size of the buffer 9549 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from 9550 * @count: read count 9551 * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock) 9552 * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler 9553 * 9554 * Return: the number of characters written, or a negative errno 9555 */ 9556 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file, 9557 char *buf, size_t bufsize, 9558 const char __user *userbuf, size_t count, 9559 ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 9560 struct file *file, 9561 char *buf, 9562 size_t count, 9563 void *data), 9564 void *data); 9565 #endif 9566 9567 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */ 9568